UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 10-K

Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934


 

 

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010

 

Commission File No. 1-5273-1


 

STERLING BANCORP

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)


 

 

 

New York

 

13-2565216

(State or other jurisdiction of

 

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

incorporation or organization)

 

 

650 Fifth Avenue, New York, N.Y.

 

10019-6108

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

(Zip Code)

(212) 757-3300
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(B) OF THE ACT:

 

 

 

 

 

NAME OF EACH EXCHANGE

TITLE OF EACH CLASS

 

ON WHICH REGISTERED

Common Shares, $1 par value per share

 

New York Stock Exchange

Cumulative Trust Preferred

 

 

Securities 8.375% (Liquidation Amount

 

 

$10 per Preferred Security) of Sterling

 

 

Bancorp Trust I and Guarantee of Sterling

 

 

Bancorp with respect thereto

 

New York Stock Exchange

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(G) OF THE ACT: NONE

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes o No þ

Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.
Yes o No þ

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes þ No o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes þ No o

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. þ

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
Large Accelerated Filer o Accelerated Filer þ Non-Accelerated Filer o Smaller Reporting Company o

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes o No þ

On June 30, 2010, the aggregate market value of the common equity held by non-affiliates of the Registrant was $228,639,330.

The Registrant has one class of common stock, of which 26,840,763 shares were outstanding at February 14, 2011.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

(1) Portions of Sterling Bancorp’s definitive Proxy Statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A are incorporated by reference in Part III.



TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

 

 

Page

PART I

 

 

 

 

Item 1.

BUSINESS

 

1

 

 

 

 

Item 1A.

RISK FACTORS

 

17

 

 

 

 

Item 1B.

UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

 

27

 

 

 

 

Item 2.

PROPERTIES

 

27

 

 

 

 

Item 3.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

 

28

 

 

 

 

Item 4.

SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

 

28

 

 

 

 

PART II

 

 

 

 

 

 

Item 5.

MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

28

 

 

 

 

Item 6.

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

30

 

 

 

 

Item 7.

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

30

 

 

 

 

Item 7A.

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

30

 

 

 

 

Item 8.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

 

57

 

 

 

 

Item 9.

CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

 

116

 

 

 

 

Item 9A.

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

116

 

 

 

 

Item 9B.

OTHER INFORMATION

 

118

 

 

 

 

PART III

 

 

 

 

Item 10.

DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

119

 

 

 

 

Item 11.

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

 

119

 

 

 

 

Item 12.

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

 

119

 

 

 

 

Item 13.

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

 

119

 

 

 

 

Item 14.

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

119

 

 

 

 

PART IV

 

 

 

 

Item 15.

EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

120

 

 

 

 

SIGNATURES

 

123


 

 

 

Exhibits Submitted in a Separate Volume.

 



PART I

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

The disclosures set forth in this item are qualified by ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS on pages 17–27 and the section captioned “FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AND FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS” on page 32 and other cautionary statements set forth elsewhere in this report.

Sterling Bancorp (the “parent company” or the “Registrant”) is a bank holding company and a financial holding company as defined by the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHCA”), which was organized in 1966. Sterling Bancorp and its subsidiaries derive substantially all of their revenue and income from providing banking and related financial services and products to customers primarily in New York, New Jersey and Connecticut (“the New York metropolitan area”). Throughout this report, the terms the “Company” or “Sterling” refer to Sterling Bancorp and its subsidiaries. The Company has operations in the New York metropolitan area and conducts business throughout the United States.

The parent company owns, directly or indirectly, all of the outstanding shares of Sterling National Bank (the “bank”), its principal subsidiary, and all of the outstanding shares of Sterling Banking Corporation and Sterling Bancorp Trust I (the “trust”). Sterling National Mortgage Company, Inc. (“SNMC”), Sterling Factors Corporation (“Factors”), Sterling Trade Services, Inc. (“Trade Services”), Sterling Resource Funding Corp. (“Resource Funding”) and Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. are wholly-owned subsidiaries of the bank.

On April 3, 2009, Factors, a subsidiary of the bank, acquired substantially all of the assets and customer lists of DCD Capital, LLC and DCD Trade Services, LLC. The acquired assets and customer lists are now operating as a division of Factors under the name Sterling Trade Capital.

In September 2006, the Company sold the business conducted by Sterling Financial Services (“Sterling Financial”). In accordance with U.S. GAAP, the assets, liabilities and earnings/loss of the business conducted by Sterling Financial have been shown separately as discontinued operations.

For purposes of the following discussion, average balances, averages rates, income and expenses associated with Sterling Financial have been excluded from continuing operations and reported separately for all periods presented.

Segment information appears in Note 25 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

BUSINESS OPERATIONS

The Bank

Sterling National Bank was organized in 1929 under the National Bank Act and commenced operations in New York City. The bank maintains twelve offices in New York: nine offices in New York City (six branches and an international banking facility in Manhattan and three branches in Queens); two branches in Nassau County (one in Great Neck and the other in Woodbury, New York) and one branch in Yonkers, New York. The executive office is located at 650 Fifth Avenue, New York, New York.

The bank provides a broad range of banking and financial products and services, including business and consumer lending, asset-based financing, factoring/accounts receivable management services, equipment financing, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, deposit services, and trade financing.

For the year ended December 31, 2010, the bank’s average earning assets represented approximately 98.3% of the Company’s average earning assets. Loans represented 61.2% and investment securities represented 36.8% of the bank’s average earning assets in 2010.

Commercial Lending, Asset-Based Financing and Factoring/Accounts Receivable Management. The bank provides loans to small and medium-sized businesses. The businesses are diversified across industries, including commercial, industrial and financial companies, and government and non-profit entities. Loans generally range in size up to $20 million and can be tailored to meet customers’ specific long- and short-term needs, and include secured and unsecured lines of credit, business installment loans, business lines of credit, and debtor-in-possession financing. Loans are often collateralized by assets, such as accounts receivable, inventory, marketable securities, other liquid collateral, equipment and other assets.

Through its factoring subsidiary, Factors, the bank provides accounts receivable management services. The purchase of a client’s accounts receivable is traditionally known as “factoring” and results in payment by the client of a nonrefundable factoring fee, which is generally a percentage of the factored receivables or sales volume and is designed to compensate for the bookkeeping and collection services provided by Factors and, if applicable, its credit review of the client’s customer and assumption of customer credit risk. When Factors “factors” (i.e., purchases) an account receivable from a client, it records the receivable as an asset (included in “Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts”), records a liability for the funds due to the client (included in “Accrued expenses and other liabilities”) and credits to noninterest income the nonrefundable

PAGE 1


factoring fee (included in “Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees”). Factors also may advance funds to its client prior to the collection of receivables, charging interest on such advances (in addition to any factoring fees) and normally satisfying such advances by the collection of receivables. The accounts receivable factored are primarily for clients engaged in the apparel and textile industries.

Through a subsidiary, Sterling Resource Funding Corp., the bank provides financing and human resource business process outsourcing support services, exclusively for the temporary staffing industry. For over 25 years and throughout the United States, Resource Funding has provided full back-office, computer, tax and accounting services, as well as financing, to independently-owned staffing companies. The average contract term is 18 months for approximately 200 staffing companies.

As of December 31, 2010, the outstanding loan balance (net of unearned discounts) for commercial and industrial lending and factored receivables was $755.5 million, representing approximately 56.8% of the bank’s total loan portfolio.

There are no industry concentrations in the commercial and industrial loan portfolio that exceed 10% of gross loans. Approximately 69% of the bank’s loans are to borrowers located in the New York metropolitan area. The bank has no foreign loans.

Equipment Financing. The bank offers equipment financing services in the New York metropolitan area and across the United States through direct leasing programs, third party sources and vendor programs. The bank finances full payout leases for various types of business equipment, written on a recourse basis—with personal guarantees of the principals, with terms generally ranging from 24 to 60 months. At December 31, 2010, the outstanding balance (net of unearned discounts) for equipment financing receivables was $144.2 million, with a remaining average term of 35 months, representing approximately 10.8% of the bank’s total loan portfolio.

Residential and Commercial Mortgages. The bank’s real estate loan portfolio consists of real estate loans on one-to-four family residential properties, multi-family residential properties and nonresidential commercial properties. The residential mortgage banking and brokerage business is conducted through offices located principally in New York. Residential mortgage loans, substantially all of which are for single family residences, are focused on conforming credit, government insured FHA and other high quality loan products and are originated primarily in the New York metropolitan area, Virginia and other mid-Atlantic states, almost all of these for resale. In addition, the Company retains in portfolio fixed and floating rate residential mortgage loans, primarily on properties located in the New York metropolitan area, which were originated by its mortgage banking subsidiary. Commercial real estate lending, including financing on multi-family residential properties and nonresidential commercial properties, is offered on income-producing investor properties and owner-occupied properties, professional co-ops and condos. At December 31, 2010, the outstanding loan balance for real estate mortgage loans was $256.7 million, representing approximately 19.3% of the bank’s total loans outstanding.

Deposit Services. The bank attracts deposits from customers located primarily in the New York metropolitan area, offering a broad array of deposit products, including checking accounts, money market accounts, negotiable order of withdrawal (“NOW”) accounts, savings accounts, rent security accounts, retirement accounts, and certificates of deposit. The bank’s deposit services include account management and information, disbursement, reconciliation, collection and concentration, ACH and others designed for specific business purposes. The deposits of the bank are insured to the extent permitted by law pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended.

Trade Finance. Through its international division and international banking facility, the bank offers financial services to its customers and correspondents in the world’s major financial centers. These services consist of financing import and export transactions, issuing letters of credit, processing documentary collections and creating banker’s acceptances. In addition, active bank account relationships are maintained with leading foreign banking institutions in major financial centers.

Foreign activities of the Company are not considered to be material with predominantly all revenues and assets attributable to customers located in the United States. As of December 31, 2010, there were no loans to or deposits from customers located outside the United States.

The composition of total revenues (interest income and non-interest income) of the bank and its subsidiaries for the three most recent fiscal years was as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Interest and fees on loans

 

 

49

%

 

48

%

 

53

%

Interest and dividends on investment securities

 

 

18

 

 

22

 

 

24

 

Noninterest income

 

 

33

 

 

29

 

 

22

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

1

 

 

 










 

 

 

100

%

 

100

%

 

100

%

 

 










At December 31, 2010, the bank and its subsidiaries had 558 full-time equivalent employees, consisting of 231 officers and

PAGE 2


327 supervisory and clerical employees. The bank considers its relations with its employees to be satisfactory.

COMPETITION

There is intense competition in all areas in which the Company conducts its business. As a result of the deregulation of the financial services industry under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, the Company competes with banks and other financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks, finance companies, and credit unions. Many of these competitors have substantially greater resources and may have higher lending limits and provide a wider array of banking services than the Company does. To a limited extent, the Company also competes with other providers of financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage firms, consumer finance companies and insurance companies. The Company generally competes on the basis of level of customer service, responsiveness to customer needs, availability and pricing of products, and geographic location.

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

General

The banking industry is highly regulated. Statutory and regulatory controls are designed primarily for the protection of depositors and the banking system, and not for the purpose of protecting the shareholders of the parent company. The following discussion is not intended to be a complete list of all the activities regulated by the banking laws or of the impact of such laws and regulations on the bank and the Company. It is intended only to briefly summarize some material provisions. Changes in applicable law or regulation, and in their interpretation and application by regulatory agencies, cannot be predicted, but they may have a material effect on the business and results of the Company.

Sterling is a bank holding company and a financial holding company under the BHCA and is subject to supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the Federal Reserve Board. Sterling is also subject to the disclosure and regulatory requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as administered by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Sterling Bancorp is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the trading symbol “STL” and is subject to the rules of the NYSE for listed companies.

As a national bank, the bank is principally subject to the supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”), as well as the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”). Insured banks, including the bank, are subject to extensive regulation of many aspects of their business. These regulations relate to, among other things: (a) the nature and amount of loans that may be made by the bank and the rates of interest that may be charged; (b) types and amounts of other investments; (c) branching; (d) permissible activities; (e) reserve requirements; and (f) dealings with officers, directors and affiliates.

Sterling Banking Corporation is subject to supervision and regulation by the Banking Department of the State of New York.

Bank Holding Company Regulation

The BHCA requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board for the acquisition by a bank holding company of 5% or more of the voting stock or substantially all of the assets of any bank or bank holding company. Also, under the BHCA, bank holding companies are prohibited, with certain exceptions, from engaging in, or from acquiring 5% or more of the voting stock of any company engaging in, activities other than (1) banking or managing or controlling banks, (2) furnishing services to or performing services for their subsidiaries, or (3) activities that the Federal Reserve Board has determined to be so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto.

As discussed below under “Financial Holding Company Regulation,” the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 amended the BHCA to permit a broader range of activities for bank holding companies that qualify as “financial holding companies.”

Financial Holding Company Regulation

The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act:

 

 

allows bank holding companies, the depository institution subsidiaries of which meet management, capital and the Community Reinvestment Act (the “CRA”) standards, to engage in a substantially broader range of non-banking financial activities than was previously permissible, including (a) insurance underwriting and agency, (b) making merchant banking investments in commercial companies, (c) securities underwriting, dealing and market making, and (d) sponsoring mutual funds and investment companies;

 

 

allows insurers and other financial services companies to acquire banks; and

 

 

establishes the overall regulatory structure applicable to bank holding companies that also engage in insurance and securities operations.

In order for a bank holding company to engage in the broader range of activities that are permitted by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, (1) all of its depository subsidiaries must be and remain “well capitalized” and “well managed” and have received at least a satisfactory CRA rating, and (2) it must file a declaration with the Federal Reserve Board that it elects to be a “financial holding company.”

PAGE 3


Requirements and standards to remain “well capitalized” are discussed below. To maintain financial holding company status, the bank must have at least a “satisfactory” rating under the CRA. Under the CRA, during examinations of the bank, the OCC is required to assess the bank’s record of meeting the credit needs of the communities serviced by the bank, including low- and moderate-income communities. Banks are given one of four ratings under the CRA: “outstanding,” “satisfactory,” “needs to improve” or “substantial non-compliance.” The bank received a rating of “outstanding” on the most recent exam completed by the OCC.

Pursuant to an election made under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, the parent company has been designated as a financial holding company. As a financial holding company, Sterling may conduct, or acquire a company (other than a U.S. depository institution or foreign bank) engaged in, activities that are “financial in nature,” as well as additional activities that the Federal Reserve Board determines (in the case of incidental activities, in conjunction with the United States Department of the Treasury (the “U.S. Treasury”) are incidental or complementary to financial activities, without the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board. Under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, activities that are financial in nature include insurance, securities underwriting and dealing, merchant banking, and sponsoring mutual funds and investment companies. Under the merchant banking authority added by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, financial holding companies may invest in companies that engage in activities that are not otherwise permissible “financial” activities, subject to certain limitations, including that the financial holding company makes the investment with the intention of limiting the investment duration and does not manage the company on a day-to-day basis.

Generally, financial holding companies must continue to meet all the requirements for financial holding company status in order to maintain the ability to undertake new activities or acquisitions that are financial in nature and the ability to continue those activities that are not generally permissible for bank holding companies. If the parent company ceases to so qualify, it would be required to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board to engage in non-banking activities or to acquire more than 5% of the voting stock of any company that is engaged in non-banking activities. With certain exceptions, the Federal Reserve Board can only provide prior approval to applications involving activities that it had previously determined, by regulation or order, are so closely related to banking as to be properly incident thereto. Such activities are more limited than the range of activities that are deemed “financial in nature.”

Dodd - Frank Act

On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed into law the Dodd-Frank Act. The Dodd-Frank Act has already resulted, and will continue to result, in sweeping changes in the regulation of financial institutions aimed at strengthening the sound operation of the financial services sector. The Dodd-Frank Act’s provisions that have received the most public attention generally have been those applying to or more likely to affect larger institutions. However, it contains numerous other provisions that will affect all banks and bank holding companies, identified below. The Dodd-Frank Act includes provisions that, among other things:

 

 

Centralize responsibility for consumer financial protection by creating a new agency, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, responsible for implementing, examining and enforcing compliance with federal consumer financial laws.

 

 

Restrict the preemption of state law by federal law and disallow subsidiaries and affiliates of national banks, such as the bank, from availing themselves of such preemption.

 

 

Apply the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies.

 

 

Require the OCC to seek to make its capital requirements for national banks, such as Sterling National Bank, counter-cyclical so that capital requirements increase in times of economic expansion and decrease in times of economic contraction.

 

 

Require financial holding companies, such as the parent company, to be well capitalized and well managed as of July 21, 2011. Bank holding companies and banks must also be both well capitalized and well managed in order to acquire banks located outside their home state.

 

 

Implement corporate governance revisions, including with regard to executive compensation and proxy access by shareholders, that apply to all public companies, not just financial institutions.

 

 

Make permanent the $250 thousand limit for federal deposit insurance and increase the cash limit of Securities Investor Protection Corporation protection from $100 thousand to $250 thousand and provide unlimited federal deposit insurance until December 31, 2012 for non-interest bearing demand transaction accounts at all insured depository institutions.

 

 

Repeal the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, thereby permitting depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts.

 

 

Increase the authority of the Federal Reserve to examine the Company and its non-bank subsidiaries.

Some of these provisions may have the consequence of increasing our expenses, decreasing our revenues, and changing the activities in which we choose to engage. The environment in which banking organizations will operate after the

PAGE 4


financial crisis, including legislative and regulatory changes affecting capital, liquidity, supervision, permissible activities, corporate governance and compensation, changes in fiscal policy and steps to eliminate government support for banking organizations, may have long-term effects on the business model and profitability of banking organizations that cannot now be foreseen. The specific impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on our current activities or new financial activities we may consider in the future, our financial performance and the markets in which we operate will depend on the manner in which the relevant agencies develop and implement the required rules and the reaction of market participants to these regulatory developments. Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to rulemaking and will take effect over several years, making it difficult to anticipate the overall financial impact on the Company, its customers or the financial industry more generally.

Payment of Dividends

The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank.

Various legal restrictions limit the extent to which the bank can fund the parent company and its nonbank subsidiaries. All national banks are limited in the payment of dividends without the approval of the OCC to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for that year-to-date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to surplus. Federal law also prohibits national banks from paying dividends that would be greater than the bank’s undivided profits after deducting statutory bad debt in excess of the bank’s allowance for loan losses. Under the foregoing restrictions, and while maintaining its “well capitalized” status, as of December 31, 2010, the bank could pay dividends of approximately $32.3 million to the parent company, without obtaining regulatory approval. This is not necessarily indicative of amounts that may be paid or are available to be paid in future periods.

Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), a depository institution, such as the bank, may not pay dividends if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or if it is already undercapitalized. The payment of dividends by the parent company and the bank may also be affected or limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital. The appropriate federal regulatory authority is authorized to determine under certain circumstances relating to the financial condition of a bank holding company or a bank that the payment of dividends would be an unsafe or unsound practice and to prohibit payment thereof. The appropriate federal regulatory authorities have indicated that paying dividends that deplete a bank’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe and unsound banking practice and that banking organizations should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings. In addition, in the current financial and economic environment, the Federal Reserve Board has indicated that bank holding companies should carefully review their dividend policy and has discouraged payment ratios that are at maximum allowable levels unless both asset quality and capital are very strong.

On December 23, 2008, the parent company issued Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Shares Series A, liquidation preference of $1,000 per share (the “Series A Preferred Shares”), to the U.S. Treasury as a participant in the Capital Purchase Program under the Troubled Asset Repurchase Program (“TARP”). Under the terms of a letter agreement the parent company executed in connection with the preferred shares issuance, prior to December 23, 2011, unless the parent company has redeemed all such preferred shares or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all such preferred shares to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for the parent company to increase the dividend on its common shares above a quarterly cash dividend of $0.19 per share.

For a discussion of additional restrictions on the parent company’s ability to pay dividends, see “Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008” beginning on page 10.

Transactions with Affiliates

Federal laws strictly limit the ability of banks to engage in transactions with their affiliates, including their bank holding companies. Regulations promulgated by the Federal Reserve Board limit the types and amounts of these transactions (including loans due and extensions of credit from their U.S. bank subsidiaries) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on an arm’s-length basis. In general, these regulations require that any “covered transactions” between a subsidiary bank and its parent company or the non-bank subsidiaries of the bank holding company are limited to 10% of a bank subsidiary’s capital and surplus and, with respect to such parent company and all such nonbank subsidiaries, to an aggregate of 20% of the bank subsidiary’s capital and surplus. Further, loans and extensions of credit generally are required to be secured by eligible collateral in specified amounts. The Dodd-Frank Act significantly expands the coverage and scope of the limitations on affiliate transactions within a banking organization. For example, commencing in July 2011, the Dodd-Frank Act will require that the 10% of capital limit on these transactions begin to apply to financial subsidiaries as well. “Covered transactions” are defined by statute to include a loan or extension of credit, as well as a purchase of securities issued by an affiliate, a purchase of assets (unless otherwise exempted by the Federal Reserve Board) from the affiliate, the acceptance of securities issued by

PAGE 5


the affiliate as collateral for a loan, and the issuance of a guarantee, acceptance or letter of credit on behalf of an affiliate.

Federal law also limits a bank’s authority to extend credit to its directors, executive officers and 10% shareholders, as well as to entities controlled by such persons. Among other things, extensions of credit to insiders are required to be made on terms that are substantially the same as, and follow credit underwriting procedures that are not less stringent than, those prevailing for comparable transactions with unaffiliated persons. Also, the terms of such extensions of credit may not involve more than the normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features and may not exceed certain limitations on the amount of credit extended to such persons, individually and in the aggregate, which limits are based, in part, on the amount of the bank’s capital.

Banks are subject to prohibitions on certain tying arrangements. A depository institution is prohibited, subject to some exceptions, from extending credit to or offering any other service, or fixing or varying the consideration for such extension of credit or service, on the condition that the customer obtain some additional service from the institution or its affiliates or not obtain services of a competitor of the institution.

Capital Adequacy

As a bank holding company, we are subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. The bank is subject to similar capital requirements administered by the OCC. The federal regulatory authorities’ risk-based capital guidelines are based upon the 1988 capital accord (“Basel I”) of the Basel Committee. The Basel Committee is a committee of central banks and bank supervisors/regulators from the major industrialized countries that develops broad policy guidelines for use by each country’s supervisors in determining the supervisory policies they apply. The requirements are intended to ensure that banking organizations have adequate capital given the risk levels of assets and off-balance sheet financial instruments. Under the requirements, banking organizations are required to maintain minimum ratios for Tier 1 capital and total capital to risk-weighted assets (including certain off-balance sheet items, such as letters of credit). For purposes of calculating the ratios, a banking organization’s assets and some of its specified off-balance sheet commitments and obligations are assigned to various risk categories. A depository institution’s or holding company’s capital, in turn, is classified in tiers, depending on type:

 

 

Core Capital (Tier 1). Currently, Tier 1 capital includes common equity, retained earnings, qualifying non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, a limited amount of qualifying cumulative perpetual stock at the holding company level, minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, less goodwill, most intangible assets and certain other assets.

 

 

Supplementary Capital (Tier 2). Currently, Tier 2 capital includes, among other things, perpetual preferred stock not meeting the Tier 1 definition, qualifying mandatory convertible debt securities, qualifying subordinated debt, and allowances for loan and lease losses, subject to limitations.

As a bank holding company, Sterling is currently required to maintain Tier 1 capital and “total capital” (the sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) equal to at least 4.0% and 8.0%, respectively, of its total risk-weighted assets (including various off-balance-sheet items, such as standby letters of credit). National banks are required to maintain similar capital levels under capital adequacy guidelines. For a depository institution to be considered “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, its Tier 1 and total capital ratios must be at least 6.0% and 10.0% on a risk-adjusted basis, respectively. The elements currently comprising Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital and the minimum Tier 1 capital and total capital ratios may in the future be subject to change, as discussed in greater detail below.

Bank holding companies and banks are also required to comply with minimum leverage ratio requirements. The leverage ratio is the ratio of a banking organization’s Tier 1 capital to its total adjusted quarterly average assets (as defined for regulatory purposes). The requirements necessitate a minimum leverage ratio of 3.0% for financial holding companies and national banks that have the highest supervisory rating. All other financial holding companies and national banks are required to maintain a minimum leverage ratio of 4.0%, unless a different minimum is specified by an appropriate regulatory authority. For a depository institution to be considered “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, its leverage ratio must be at least 5.0%. The bank regulatory agencies have encouraged banking organizations, including healthy, well-run banking organizations, to operate with capital ratios substantially in excess of the stated ratios required to maintain “well capitalized” status. This has resulted from, among other things, current economic conditions, the global financial crisis and the likelihood, as described below, of increased formal capital requirements for banking organizations. In light of the foregoing, the Company and the bank expect that they will maintain capital ratios substantially in excess of these ratios.

In 2004, the Basel Committee published a new capital accord (“Basel II”) to replace Basel I. Basel II provides two approaches for setting capital standards for credit risk—an internal ratings-based approach tailored to individual institutions’ circumstances and a standardized approach that bases risk weightings on external credit assessments to a much greater

PAGE 6


extent than permitted in existing risk-based capital guidelines. Basel II also sets capital requirements for operational risk and refines the existing capital requirements for market risk exposures.

In the United States, regulators have required the advanced approaches of Basel II to be implemented only by certain large or internationally active banking organizations, or “core banks”—defined as those with consolidated total assets of $250 billion or more or consolidated on-balance sheet foreign exposures of $10 billion or more. Other U.S. banking organizations can elect to adopt the requirements of this rule (if they meet applicable qualification requirements), but they are not required to apply them. The rule also allows a banking organization’s primary federal supervisor to determine that the application of the rule would not be appropriate in light of the bank’s asset size, level of complexity, risk profile, or scope of operations. The Company is not required to comply with the advanced approaches of Basel II.

The Dodd-Frank Act requires the Federal Reserve Board, the OCC and the FDIC to adopt regulations imposing a continuing “floor” of the Basel I-based capital requirements in cases where the Basel II-based capital requirements and any changes in capital regulations resulting from Basel III (see below) otherwise would permit lower requirements. In December 2010, the Federal Reserve Board, the OCC and the FDIC issued a joint notice of proposed rulemaking that would implement this requirement.

In December 2010, the Basel Committee released its final framework for strengthening international capital and liquidity regulation, now officially identified by the Basel Committee as “Basel III”. Basel III, when implemented by the U.S. banking agencies and fully phased-in, will require bank holding companies and their bank subsidiaries to maintain substantially more capital, with a greater emphasis on common equity.

The Basel III final capital framework, among other things, (i) introduces as a new capital measure “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”), (ii) specifies that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, (iii) defines CET1 narrowly by requiring that most adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital and (iv) expands the scope of the adjustments as compared to existing regulations.

When fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, Basel III requires banks to maintain (i) as a newly adopted international standard, a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 4.5%, plus a 2.5% “capital conservation buffer” (which is added to the 4.5% CET1 ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7%), (ii) a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 6.0%, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 6.0% Tier 1 capital ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 8.5% upon full implementation), (iii) a minimum ratio of Total (that is, Tier 1 plus Tier 2) capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 8.0%, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 8.0% total capital ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum total capital ratio of 10.5% upon full implementation) and (iv) as a newly adopted international standard, a minimum leverage ratio of 3%, calculated as the ratio of Tier 1 capital to balance sheet exposures plus certain off-balance sheet exposures (as the average for each quarter of the month-end ratios for the quarter).

Basel III also provides for a “countercyclical capital buffer,” generally to be imposed when national regulators determine that excess aggregate credit growth becomes associated with a buildup of systemic risk, that would be a CET1 add-on to the capital conservation buffer in the range of 0% to 2.5% when fully implemented (potentially resulting in total buffers of between 2.5% and 5%).

The aforementioned capital conservation buffer is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. Banking institutions with a ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets above the minimum but below the conservation buffer (or below the combined capital conservation buffer and counter-cyclical capital buffer, when the latter is applied) will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the short fall.

The implementation of the Basel III final framework will commence January 1, 2013. On that date, banking institutions will be required to meet the following minimum capital ratios:

 

 

3.5% CET1 to risk-weighted assets.

 

 

4.5% Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets.

 

 

8.0% Total capital to risk-weighted assets.

The Basel III final framework provides for a number of new deductions from and adjustments to CET1. These include, for example, the requirement that mortgage servicing rights, deferred tax assets dependent upon future taxable income and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such categories in the aggregate exceed 15% of CET1.

Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 will begin on January 1, 2014 and will be phased-in over a five-year period (20% per year). The implementation of the capital conservation buffer will begin on January 1, 2016 at 0.625% and be phased-in over a four-year period

PAGE 7


(increasing by that amount on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019).

The U.S. banking agencies have indicated informally that they expect to propose regulations implementing Basel III in mid-2011 with final adoption of implementing regulations in mid-2012. Notwithstanding its release of the Basel III framework as a final framework, the Basel Committee is considering further amendments to Basel III, including the imposition of additional capital surcharges on globally systemically important financial institutions. In addition to Basel III, Dodd-Frank requires or permits the Federal banking agencies to adopt regulations affecting banking institutions’ capital requirements in a number of respects, including potentially more stringent capital requirements for systemically important financial institutions. Accordingly, the regulations ultimately applicable to the Company may be substantially different from the Basel III final framework as published in December 2010.

Prompt Corrective Action

The Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended (“FDIA”), requires, among other things, the federal banking agencies to take “prompt corrective action” in respect of depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. The FDIA sets forth the following five capital tiers: “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized.” A depository institution’s capital tier will depend upon how its capital levels compare with various relevant capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation. The relevant capital measures are the total capital ratio, the Tier 1 capital ratio and the leverage ratio.

A bank will be: (i) “well capitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater, and a leverage ratio of 5.0% or greater, and is not subject to any order or written directive by any such regulatory authority to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure; (ii) “adequately capitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.0% or greater, and a leverage ratio of 4.0% or greater and is not “well capitalized”; (iii) “undercapitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based ratio that is less than 8.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 4.0%; (iv) “significantly undercapitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 3.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 3.0%; and (v) “critically under-capitalized” if the institution’s tangible equity is equal to or less than 2.0% of average quarterly tangible assets. An institution may be downgraded to, or deemed to be in, a capital category that is lower than that indicated by its capital ratios if it is determined to be in an unsafe or unsound condition or if it receives an unsatisfactory examination rating with respect to certain matters. As of December 31, 2010, the Company and the bank were “well capitalized,” based on the ratios and guidelines described above. A bank’s capital category is determined solely for the purpose of applying prompt corrective action regulations, and the capital category may not constitute an accurate representation of the bank’s overall financial condition or prospects for other purposes.

The FDIA generally prohibits a depository institution from making any capital distributions (including payment of a dividend) or paying any management fee to its parent holding company if the depository institution would thereafter be undercapitalized. Undercapitalized institutions are subject to growth limitations and are required to submit a capital restoration plan. The agencies may not accept such a plan without determining, among other things, that the plan is based on realistic assumptions and is likely to succeed in restoring the depository institution’s capital. In addition, for a capital restoration plan to be acceptable, the depository institution’s parent holding company must guarantee that the institution will comply with such a capital restoration plan. The aggregate liability of the parent holding company is limited to the lesser of (i) an amount equal to 5.0% of the depository institution’s total assets at the time it became undercapitalized and (ii) the amount which is necessary (or would have been necessary) to bring the institution into compliance with all capital standards applicable with respect to such institution as of the time it fails to comply with the plan. If a depository institution fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is “significantly undercapitalized.”

“Significantly undercapitalized” depository institutions may be subject to a number of requirements and restrictions, including orders to sell sufficient voting stock to become “adequately capitalized,” requirements to reduce total assets, and cessation of receipt of deposits from correspondent banks. “Critically undercapitalized” institutions are subject to the appointment of a receiver or conservator.

Support of the Bank

Federal Reserve Board policy historically required a bank holding company to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks. The Dodd-Frank Act codifies this policy as a statutory requirement. As a result, the Federal Reserve Board may require the parent company to stand ready to use its resources to provide adequate capital funds to its banking subsidiaries during periods of financial stress or adversity. This support may be required at times by the Federal Reserve Board even though not expressly required

PAGE 8


by regulation and even though the parent company may not be in a financial position to provide such support. In addition, any capital loans by a bank holding company to any of its subsidiary banks are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary banks. The BHCA provides that, in the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to priority of payment. Furthermore, under the National Bank Act, if the capital stock of the bank is impaired by losses or otherwise, the OCC is authorized to require payment of the deficiency by assessment upon the parent company. If the assessment is not paid within three months, the OCC could order a sale of the capital stock of the bank held by the parent company to make good the deficiency.

FDIC Insurance

The FDIC utilizes a risk-based assessment system that imposes insurance premiums based upon a risk matrix that, as described below, takes into account, among other things, a bank’s capital level and supervisory rating (its “CAMELS rating”).

Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Act of 2005, which became law in 2006, the bank received a one-time assessment credit that can be applied against future premiums through 2010, subject to certain limitations. Any increase in insurance assessments could have an adverse impact on the earnings of insured institutions, including the bank. The bank paid a deposit insurance premium in 2010 amounting to $2.9 million.

In addition, the bank is required to make payments for the servicing of obligations of the Financing Corporation (“FICO”) issued in connection with the resolution of savings and loan associations, so long as such obligations remain outstanding. The bank paid a FICO assessment in 2010 amounting to $200 thousand. The FICO annualized assessment rate for the first quarter of 2011 is 1.02 cents per $100 of deposits.

The enactment of Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (“EESA”) temporarily raised the basic limit on federal deposit insurance coverage from $100,000 to $250,000 per depositor through December 31, 2009. The temporary increase in deposit insurance coverage became effective on October 3, 2008. On May 20, 2009, the FDIC announced that the temporary increase in the basic deposit insurance limit has been extended through December 31, 2013.

On November 21, 2008, the Board of Directors of the FDIC adopted a final rule relating to the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (“TLG Program”). The TLG Program was announced by the FDIC on October 14, 2008, preceded by the determination of systemic risk by the Secretary of the Department of Treasury (after consultation with the President), as an initiative to counter the system-wide crisis in the nation’s financial sector. Under the TLG Program the FDIC would (i) guarantee, through the earlier of maturity or June 30, 2012, certain newly issued senior unsecured debt issued by participating institutions on or after October 14, 2008, and before June 30, 2009 and (ii) provide full FDIC deposit insurance coverage for non-interest bearing transaction deposit accounts, NOW accounts paying less than 0.5%interest per annum and Interest on Lawyers Trust Accounts held at participating FDIC-insured institutions through June 30, 2010. Although the deposit insurance program was originally scheduled to expire on December 31, 2009, the FDIC implemented a final rule, effective as of October 1, 2009, extending the transaction account guarantee program by six months until June 30, 2010 (subject to the option of participating institutions to opt out of such six-month extension). The bank did not choose to opt out of the six-month extension. Coverage under the TLG Program was available for the first 30 days without charge. The fee assessment for coverage of senior unsecured debt ranges from 50 basis points to 100 basis points per annum, depending on the initial maturity of the debt. The fee assessment for deposit insurance coverage is 10 basis points per annum on amounts in covered accounts exceeding $250,000, payable quarterly. On December 5, 2008, the bank elected to participate in the deposit insurance program and declined, along with the parent company, to participate in the debt guarantee program.

On November 17, 2009, the FDIC implemented a final rule requiring insured institutions to prepay their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009, and for all of 2010, 2011 and 2012. Such prepaid assessments were collected by the FDIC on December 30, 2009, along with each institution’s quarterly risk-based deposit insurance assessment for the third quarter of 2009.

In November 2010, the FDIC issued a final rule to implement provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that provide for temporary unlimited coverage for non-interest-bearing transaction accounts. The separate coverage for non-interest-bearing transaction accounts became effective on December 31, 2010 and terminates on December 31, 2012.

In February 2011, the FDIC also issued a final rule to change the deposit insurance assessment base from total domestic deposits to average total assets minus average tangible equity, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act, effective April 1, 2011. The FDIC also issued a final rule that revises the initial and base assessment rate schedule, effective April 1, 2011. The initial base assessment rate will range from 5 to 35 basis points on an annualized basis (basis points representing cents

PAGE 9


per $100 of assessable assets). After the effect of potential base-rate adjustments, the total base assessment rate could range from 2.5 to 45 basis points on an annualized basis. The potential adjustments to an institution’s initial base assessment rate include (i) a potential decrease of up to 5 basis points for certain long-term unsecured debt (“unsecured debt adjustment”) and, except for well-capitalized institutions with a CAMELS rating of 1 or 2, (ii) a potential increase of up to 10 basis points for brokered deposits in excess of 10% of domestic deposits (“brokered deposit adjustment”). As the DIF reserve ratio grows, the rate schedule will be adjusted downward. Additionally, the rule includes a new adjustment for depository institution debt whereby an institution will pay an additional premium equal to 50 basis points on every dollar (above 3% of an institution’s Tier 1 capital) of long-term, unsecured debt held that was issued by another insured depository institution (excluding debt guaranteed under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program). Either an increase in the Risk Category of the bank or adjustments to the base assessment rates could have a material adverse effect on our earnings.

Under the FDIA, insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order, or condition imposed by the FDIC.

In its resolution of the problems of an insured depository institution in default or in danger of default, the FDIC is generally required to satisfy its obligations to insured depositors at the least possible cost to the DIF. In addition, the FDIC may not take any action that would have the effect of increasing the losses to the deposit insurance fund by protecting depositors for more than the insured portion of deposits or creditors other than depositors.

Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008

In response to unprecedented market turmoil during the third quarter of 2008, the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 was enacted on October 3, 2008. EESA authorized the U.S. Treasury to provide up to $700 billion to support the financial services industry.

Pursuant to authority under EESA, the U.S. Treasury created the TARP Capital Purchase Program under which the U.S. Treasury was authorized to invest up to $250 billion in senior preferred stock of U.S. banks and savings associations or their holding companies. Qualifying financial institutions were permitted to issue senior preferred stock with a value equal to not less than 1% of risk-weighted assets and not more than the lesser of $25 billion or 3% of risk-weighted assets. The preferred stock will pay dividends at the rate of 5% per annum until the fifth anniversary of the investment and thereafter at the rate of 9% per annum. No dividends may be paid on common stock unless dividends have been paid on the senior preferred stock. Until the third anniversary of the issuance of the senior preferred, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for any increase in the dividends on common stock or for any stock repurchases unless the senior preferred has been redeemed in its entirety or the U.S. Treasury has transferred the senior preferred to third parties. The senior preferred will not have voting rights other than the right to vote as a class on the issuance of any preferred stock ranking senior, any change in its terms or any merger, exchange or similar transaction that would adversely affect its rights. The senior preferred will also have the right to elect two directors if dividends have not been paid for six periods. The senior preferred will be freely transferable and participating institutions will be required to file a shelf registration statement covering the senior preferred. The issuing institution must grant the U.S. Treasury piggyback registration rights. Prior to issuance, the financial institution and its senior executive officers must modify or terminate all benefit plans and arrangements to comply with EESA. Senior executives must also waive any claims against the U.S. Treasury.

In connection with the issuance of the senior preferred, participating institutions must issue to the U.S. Treasury immediately exercisable 10-year warrants to purchase common stock with an aggregate market price equal to 15% of the amount of senior preferred. The exercise price of the warrants will equal the market price of the common stock on the date of the investment. The U.S. Treasury will not exercise voting rights with respect to any shares of common stock acquired through exercise of the warrants. The financial institution must file a shelf registration statement covering the warrants and underlying common stock as soon as practicable after issuance and grant piggyback registration rights.

On December 23, 2008, the parent company issued preferred shares and a warrant to purchase its common shares to the U.S. Treasury as a participant in the TARP Capital Purchase Program. The amount of capital raised in that transaction was $42 million, approximately three percent of the Company’s risk-weighted assets. Prior to December 23, 2011, unless the parent company has redeemed all such preferred shares or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all such preferred shares to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to, among other things, increase the dividend on the parent company’s common shares above a quarterly cash dividend of $0.19 per share or repurchase our common shares or outstanding preferred shares except in limited circumstances. Sterling filed a registration statement on Form S-3 covering

PAGE 10


the preferred stock, the warrant and underlying common stock, as required under the terms of the TARP investment, on January 22, 2009. The registration statement was declared effective by the SEC on April 13, 2009.

In addition, until the U.S. Treasury ceases to own any of the Company’s securities sold under the TARP Capital Purchase Program, the compensation arrangements for our senior executive officers must comply in all respects with EESA and the rules and regulations there under. In compliance with such requirements, each of our senior executive officers in December 2008 agreed in writing to accept the compensation standards in existence at that time under the TARP Capital Purchase Program and thereby cap or eliminate some of their contractual or legal rights. The provisions agreed to were as follows:

 

 

No Golden Parachute Payments. “Golden parachute payment” under the TARP Capital Purchase Program means a severance payment resulting from involuntary termination of employment, or from bankruptcy of the employer, that exceeds three times the terminated employee’s average base salary over the five years prior to termination. Our senior executive officers have agreed to forgo all golden parachute payments for as long as two conditions remain true: they remain “senior executive officers” (CEO, CFO and the next three highest-paid executive officers), and the U.S. Treasury continues to hold our equity securities the parent company issued to it under the TARP Capital Purchase Program (the period during which the U.S. Treasury holds those securities is the “CPP Covered Period”).

 

 

Recovery of Bonus and Incentive Compensation if Based on Certain Material Inaccuracies. Our senior executive officers have also agreed to a “clawback provision,” which means that the parent company can recover incentive compensation paid during the CPP Covered Period that is later found to have been based on materially inaccurate financial statements or other materially inaccurate measurements of performance.

 

 

No Compensation Arrangements That Encourage Excessive Risks. During the CPP Covered Period, the parent company is not allowed to enter into or maintain compensation arrangements that encourage senior executive officers to take “unnecessary and excessive risks that threaten the value” of the Company. To make sure this does not happen, our Compensation Committee is required to meet at least once a year with our senior risk officer to review our executive compensation arrangements in the light of our risk management policies and practices. Our senior risk officer will, if required to, review our executive compensation arrangements in light of our risk management policies and practices. Our senior executive officers’ written agreements include their obligation to execute whatever documents the parent company may require in order to make any changes in compensation arrangements resulting from the Compensation Committee’s review.

 

 

Limit on Federal Income Tax Deductions. During the CPP Covered Period, the parent company is not allowed to take federal income tax deductions for compensation paid to senior executive officers in excess of $500 thousand per year, with certain exceptions that do not apply to our senior executive officers.

See “Liquidity Risk” beginning on page 53 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS—ASSET/ LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” for a further discussion of our participation in the U.S. Treasury TARP Capital Purchase Program.

 

 

American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009

 

 

On February 17, 2009, President Obama signed the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”) into law. ARRA modified the compensation-related limitations contained in the TARP Capital Purchase Program, created additional compensation-related limitations and directed the Secretary of the Treasury to establish standards for executive compensation applicable to participants in TARP, regardless of when participation commenced. Thus, the newly enacted compensation-related limitations are applicable to the Company and to the extent the U.S. Treasury may implement these restrictions unilaterally the Company will apply these provisions. The provisions may be retroactive. The compensation-related limitations applicable to the Company which have been added or modified by ARRA are as follows, which provisions must be included in standards established by the U.S. Treasury:

 

 

No Severance Payments. Under ARRA, “golden parachutes” were redefined as any severance payment resulting from involuntary termination of employment, or from bankruptcy of the employer, except for payments for services performed or benefits accrued. Consequently, under ARRA the Company is prohibited from making any severance payment to our “senior executive officers” (defined in ARRA as the five highest paid executive officers) and our next five most highly compensated employees during the CPP Covered Period.

 

 

Recovery of Incentive Compensation if Based on Certain Material Inaccuracies. ARRA also contains the “clawback provision” discussed above but extends its application to any bonus or retention awards and other incentive compensation paid to any of our senior executive officers or next 20 most highly compensated employees during the CPP Covered Period that is later found to have been based on materially inaccurate financial statements or other materially inaccurate measurements of performance.

 

 

No Compensation Arrangements That Encourage Earnings Manipulation. Under ARRA, during the CPP Covered Period,

PAGE 11



 

 

 

the parent company is not allowed to enter into compensation arrangements that encourage manipulation of the reported earnings of the Company to enhance the compensation of any of our employees.

 

 

Limits on Incentive Compensation. ARRA contains a provision that prohibits the payment or accrual of any bonus, retention award or incentive compensation to any of our 5 most highly compensated employees during the CPP Covered Period other than awards of long-term restricted stock that (i) do not fully vest during the CPP Coverage Period, (ii) have a value not greater than one-third of the total annual compensation of the awardee and (iii) are subject to such other restrictions as determined by the Secretary of the Treasury. The prohibition on bonus, incentive compensation and retention awards does not preclude payments required under written employment contracts entered into on or prior to February 11, 2009.

 

 

Compensation Committee Functions. ARRA requires that our Compensation Committee be comprised solely of independent directors and that it meet at least semiannually to discuss and evaluate our employee compensation plans in light of an assessment of any risk posed to us from such compensation plans.

 

 

Compliance Certifications. ARRA also requires a written certification by our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of our compliance with the provisions of ARRA. These certifications must be contained in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009 and any subsequent year during the Capital Purchase Plan Covered Period the relevant U.S. Treasury regulations are issued.

 

 

Treasury Review of Excessive Bonuses Previously Paid. ARRA directs the Secretary of the Treasury to review all compensation paid to our senior executive officers and our next 20 most highly compensated employees to determine whether any such payments were inconsistent with the purposes of ARRA or were otherwise contrary to the public interest. If the Secretary of the Treasury makes such a finding, the Secretary of the Treasury is directed to negotiate with the TARP Capital Purchase Program recipient and the subject employee for appropriate reimbursements to the federal government with respect to the compensation and bonuses.

 

 

Say on Pay. Under ARRA the SEC promulgated rules requiring a non-binding say on pay vote by the shareholders on executive compensation at the annual meeting during the CPP Covered Period.

ARRA also provides that the U.S. Treasury, after consultation with the Company’s federal regulator, permit the Company at any time to redeem our Series A Preferred Shares at liquidation value. Upon such redemption, the warrant to purchase the parent company’s common shares that was issued to the U.S. Treasury may also be repurchased at its then current fair value or if the parent company does not elect to repurchase the warrant or the parent company and the U.S. Treasury cannot agree on the fair value of the warrant, the warrant would be sold publicly by the U.S. Treasury.

On June 10, 2009, the U.S. Treasury issued guidance on the compensation and corporate governance standards that apply to TARP recipients, as summarized below:

 

 

Bonuses accrued or paid before the effective date of the rule adopted by the U.S. Treasury are not subject to the rule’s bonus payment limitation. In addition, separation pay for departures that occurred before receipt of TARP assistance also is not subject to the limits of the rule (even if payments continue to be made after effectiveness).

 

 

The term “most highly compensated employees” covers all employees, not only executive officers or other policy makers. The determination of the most highly compensated employees is based on annual compensation for the prior year calculated in accordance with SEC disclosure rules.

 

 

The rule permits salary paid in property, including stock, so long as it is based on a dollar amount (not a number of shares), is fully vested and accrues as cash salary would. The rule also permits salary paid in stock units in respect of shares of the TARP recipient, or subsidiaries or divisions of the TARP recipient (though not below the subsidiary or division for which the employee directly provides services). Holding periods also are permitted.

 

 

Commission payments for sales, brokerage and asset management services for unrelated customers will not be subject to the bonus restrictions, but only if they are consistent with an existing plan of the TARP recipient in effect before February 17, 2009.

 

 

The rule imposes a restrictive set of “best practices” on TARP recipients: (i) the five senior executive officers and the next 20 most highly compensated employees may not receive any tax “gross-up” payment of any kind, including payments to cover taxes due on company-provided benefits or separation payments; (ii) the prohibition on separation payments to the five senior executive officers and the next five most highly compensated employees is extended to payments in connection with a change in control; (iii) the compensation committee must review all employee compensation plans every six months for unnecessary risk and provide an expanded certification including narrative disclosure of its analysis and conclusions; (iv) TARP recipients must exercise their clawback rights unless doing so would be unreasonable; and (v) TARP recipients must adopt a policy reasonably designed to eliminate excessive or luxury expenditures.

 

 

An institution will not become subject to the compensation standards merely as a result of acquiring a TARP recipient. In addition, if an acquiror is not subject to the standards

PAGE 12



 

 

 

immediately after the transaction, any employees of the acquiror (including former employees of the TARP recipient who become acquiror employees as a result of the transaction) will not be subject to the standards.

 

 

The “TARP period” during which the compensation standards apply ceases when the obligations arising from financial assistance cease and specifically excludes any period when the only outstanding obligation of a TARP recipient consists of U.S. Treasury warrants to purchase common stock.

 

 

Incentive Compensation

In June 2010, the Federal Reserve, OCC and FDIC issued comprehensive final guidance on incentive compensation policies intended to ensure that the incentive compensation policies of banking organizations do not undermine the safety and soundness of such organizations by encouraging excessive risk-taking. The incentive compensation guidelines, which cover all employees that have the ability to materially affect the risk profile of an organization, either individually or as part of a group, are based upon the key principles that a banking organization’s incentive compensation arrangements should (i) provide incentives that do not encourage risk-taking beyond the organization’s ability to effectively identify and manage risks, (ii) be compatible with effective internal controls and risk management, and (iii) be supported by strong corporate governance, including active and effective oversight by the organization’s board of directors.

The Federal Reserve will review, as part of the regular, risk-focused examination process, the incentive compensation arrangements of banking organizations, such as the Company, that are not “large, complex banking organizations.” These reviews will be tailored to each organization based on the scope and complexity of the organization’s activities and the prevalence of incentive compensation arrangements. The findings of the supervisory initiatives will be included in reports of examination. Deficiencies will be incorporated into the organization’s supervisory ratings, which can affect the organization’s ability to make acquisitions and take other actions. Enforcement actions may be taken against a banking organization if its incentive compensation arrangements, or related risk-management control or governance processes, pose a risk to the organization’s safety and soundness and the organization is not taking prompt and effective measures to correct the deficiencies.

The scope and content of the U.S. banking regulators’ policies on executive compensation are continuing to develop and are likely to continue evolving in the near future. It cannot be determined at this time whether compliance with such policies will adversely affect the ability of Sterling and its subsidiaries to hire, retain and motivate its and their key employees.

 

Depositor Preference

 

The FDIA provides that, in the event of the “liquidation or other resolution” of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution, including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors, and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver, will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If an insured depository institution fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, including the parent bank holding company, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution.

 

Liability of Commonly Controlled Institutions

 

The FDIA provides that a depository institution insured by the FDIC can be held liable by the FDIC for any loss incurred, or reasonably expected to be incurred, in connection with the default of a commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institution or in connection with any assistance provided by the FDIC to a commonly controlled institution “in danger of default” (as defined in the FDIA).

 

Community Reinvestment Act

 

The CRA requires depository institutions to assist in meeting the credit needs of their market areas consistent with safe and sound banking practice. Under the CRA, each depository institution is required to help meet the credit needs of its market areas by, among other things, providing credit to low- and moderate-income individuals and communities. Depository institutions are periodically examined for compliance with the CRA and are assigned ratings. In order for a financial holding company to commence any new activity permitted by the BHCA, or to acquire any company engaged in any new activity permitted by the BHCA, each insured depository institution subsidiary of the financial holding company must have received a rating of at least “satisfactory” in its most recent examination under the CRA. Furthermore, banking regulators take into account CRA ratings when considering approval of a proposed transaction.

 

Financial Privacy

 

In accordance with the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, federal banking regulators adopted rules that limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose non-public information about consumers to nonaffiliated third parties. These limitations require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a nonaffiliated third party. The privacy provisions of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial companies and conveyed to outside vendors.

PAGE 13



 

Anti-Money Laundering Initiatives and the USA Patriot Act

 

A major focus of governmental policy on financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA Patriot Act of 2001 (the “USA Patriot Act”) substantially broadened the scope of United States anti-money laundering laws and regulations by imposing significant new compliance and due diligence obligations, creating new crimes and penalties and expanding the extra-territorial jurisdiction of the United States. The U.S. Treasury has issued a number of implementing regulations which apply to various requirements of the USA Patriot Act to financial institutions such as the Company. These regulations impose obligations on financial institutions to maintain appropriate policies, procedures and controls to detect, prevent and report money laundering and terrorist financing and to verify the identity of their customers. Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing, or to comply with all of the relevant laws or regulations, could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution, including the imposition of enforcement actions and civil monetary penalties.

 

Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation

 

The United States has imposed economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others. These sanctions, which are administered by the U.S. Treasury Department Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”), take many different forms. Generally, however, they contain one or more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on “U.S. persons” engaging in financial transactions relating to making investments in, or providing investment-related advice or assistance to, a sanctioned country; and (ii) a blocking of assets in which the government or specially designated nationals of the sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in the possession or control of U.S. persons). Blocked assets (for example, property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, set off or transferred in any manner without a license from OFAC. Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal, financial and reputational consequences.

 

Legislative Initiatives and Regulatory Reform

 

From time to time, various legislative and regulatory initiatives are introduced in Congress and state legislatures, as well as by regulatory agencies. Such initiatives may include proposals to expand or contract the powers of bank holding companies and depository institutions or proposals to substantially change the financial institution regulatory system. Such legislation could change banking statutes and the operating environment of the Company in substantial and unpredictable ways. If enacted, such legislation could increase or decrease the cost of doing business, limit or expand permissible activities or affect the competitive balance among banks, savings associations, credit unions and other financial institutions. The Company cannot predict whether any such legislation will be enacted, and, if enacted, the effect that it, or any implementing regulations, would have on the financial condition or results of operations of the Company. A change in statutes, regulations or regulatory policies applicable to the Company could have a material effect on the business of the Company.

 

As a result of the continued volatility and instability in the financial system, the Congress, the bank regulatory authorities and other government agencies have called for or proposed additional regulation and restrictions on the activities, practices and operations of banks and their holding companies. The Congress and the federal banking agencies have broad authority to require all banks and holding companies to adhere to more rigorous or costly operating procedures, corporate governance procedures, or to engage in activities or practices which they would not otherwise elect.

 

We cannot predict whether or in what form further legislation and/or regulations may be adopted or the extent to which Sterling’s business may be affected thereby.

 

Safety and Soundness Standards

 

Federal banking agencies promulgate safety and soundness standards relating to, among other things, internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees, and benefits. With respect to internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems, the standards describe the functions that adequate internal controls and information systems must be able to perform, including: (i) monitoring adherence to prescribed policies; (ii) effective risk management; (iii) timely and accurate financial, operations, and regulatory reporting;(iv) safeguarding and managing assets; and (v) compliance with applicable laws and regulations. The standards also include requirements that: (i) those performing internal audits be qualified and independent; (ii) internal controls and information systems be tested and reviewed; (iii) corrective actions be adequately documented; and (iv) results of an audit be made available for review of management actions. In addition, federal banking agencies adopted regulations that authorize, but do not require, an agency to order an institution that has been given notice by an agency that it is not satisfying any of such safety and soundness standards to submit a compliance plan. If, after being so notified, an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material

PAGE 14



 

respect to implement an acceptable compliance plan, the agency must issue an order directing action to correct the deficiency and may issue an order directing other actions of the types to which an undercapitalized institution is subject under the “prompt corrective action” provisions of the FDIA. See “Prompt Corrective Action” above. If an institution fails to comply with such an order, the agency may seek to enforce such order in judicial proceedings and to impose civil money penalties.

 

Consequences of Non-compliance with Supervision or Regulation

 

Federal banking law grants substantial enforcement powers to federal banking regulators. This enforcement authority includes, among other things, the ability to assess civil money penalties, to issue cease-and-desist or removal orders and to initiate injunctive actions against banking organizations and institution-affiliated parties. In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of laws and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices. Other actions or inactions may provide the basis for enforcement action, including misleading or untimely reports filed with regulatory authorities.

 

The bank and its “institution-affiliated parties,” including its management, employees, agents, independent contractors, consultants such as attorneys and accountants and others who participate in the conduct of the financial institution’s affairs, are subject to potential civil and criminal penalties for violations of law, regulations or written orders of a government agency. In addition, regulators are provided with greater flexibility to commence enforcement actions against institutions and institution-affiliated parties. Possible enforcement actions include the termination of deposit insurance and cease-and-desist orders. Such orders may, among other things, require affirmative action to correct any harm resulting from a violation or practice, including restitution, reimbursement, indemnifications or guarantees against loss. A financial institution may also be ordered to restrict its growth, dispose of certain assets, rescind agreements or contracts, or take other actions as determined by the ordering agency to be appropriate.

 

Under provisions of the federal securities laws, a determination by a court or regulatory agency that certain violations have occurred at a company or its affiliates can result in fines, restitution, a limitation of permitted activities, disqualification to continue to conduct certain activities and an inability to rely on certain favorable exemptions. Certain types of infractions and violations can also affect a public company in its timing and ability to expeditiously issue new securities into the capital markets.

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED STATISTICAL INFORMATION

 

 

I.

Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity; Interest Rates and Interest Differential

The information appears on pages 50 and 51 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

 

 

II.

Investment Portfolio

A summary of the Company’s investment securities by type with related carrying values at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years appears beginning on page 41 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” Information regarding book values and range of maturities by type of security and weighted average yields for totals of each category appears on pages 42 and 43 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

 

 

III.

Loan Portfolio

A table setting forth the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio, net of unearned discounts, at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears beginning on page 43 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

A table setting forth the maturities and sensitivity to changes in interest rates of the Company’s commercial and industrial loans at December 31, 2010 appears on page 44 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

It is the policy of the Company to consider all customer requests for extensions of original maturity dates (rollovers), whether in whole or in part, as though each was an application for a new loan subject to standard approval criteria, including credit evaluation. Additional information appears under “Loan Portfolio” beginning on page 43 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS” and under “Loans” in Note 1 and in Note 6 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

A table setting forth the aggregate amount of domestic nonaccrual, past due and restructured loans of the Company at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 45 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS”; there were no foreign loans accounted

PAGE 15


for on a nonaccrual basis. Information regarding loans that have undergone a troubled debt restructuring and impaired loans is presented under “Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses” in Note 6 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Loan concentration information is presented in Note 6 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Information regarding Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock is presented in Note 7 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

 

IV.

Summary of Loan Loss Experience

A summary of loan loss experience appears in Note 6 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements and beginning on page 44 under “Asset Quality” in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” A table setting forth certain information with respect to the Company’s loan loss experience for each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 47 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

The Company considers its allowance for loan losses to be adequate based upon the size and risk characteristics of the outstanding loan portfolio at December 31, 2010. Net losses within the loan portfolio are not, however, statistically predictable and are subject to various external factors that are beyond the control of the Company. Consequently, changes in conditions in the next twelve months could result in future provisions for loan losses varying from the provision recorded in 2010.

A table presenting the Company’s allocation of the allowance at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 48 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” This allocation is based on estimates by management that may vary based on management’s evaluation of the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio. The amount allocated to a particular loan category may not necessarily be indicative of actual future charge-offs in that loan category.

 

 

V.

Deposits

Average deposits and average rates paid for each of the three most recent years are presented on page 50 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

Outstanding time certificates of deposit issued from domestic and foreign offices and interest expense on domestic and foreign deposits are presented in Note 9 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

The table providing selected information with respect to the Company’s deposits for each of the three most recent fiscal years appears on page 49 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

Interest expense for the three most recent fiscal years is presented in Note 9 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

 

VI.

Return on Assets and Equity

The Company’s returns on average total assets and average shareholders’ equity, dividend payout ratio and average shareholders’ equity to average total assets for each of the five most recent years is presented in “SELECTED F INANCIAL DATA” on page 31.

 

 

VII.

Short-Term Borrowings

Balance and rate data for significant categories of the Company’s short-term borrowings for each of the three most recent years is presented in Note 10 and in Note 11 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

PAGE 16


INFORMATION AVAILABLE ON OUR WEB SITE

The Company’s Internet address is www.sterlingbancorp.com and the investor relations section of our web site is located at www.sterlingbancorp.com/ir/investor.cfm. The Company makes available free of charge, on or through the investor relations section of the Company’s web site, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the SEC.

Also posted on the Company’s web site, and available in print upon request of any shareholder to our Investor Relations Department, are the Charters for our Board of Directors’ Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee, our Corporate Governance Guidelines, our Method for Interested Persons to Communicate with Non-Management Directors, our policy on excessive or luxury expenditures and a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics governing our directors, officers and employees. Within the time period required by the SEC and the NYSE, the Company will post on our web site any amendment to the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and any waiver applicable to our senior financial officers, as defined in the Code, or our executive officers or directors. In addition, information concerning purchases and sales of our equity securities by our executive officers and directors is posted on our web site. The contents of the Company’s web site are not incorporated by reference into this annual report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS

An investment in the parent company’s common shares is subject to risks inherent to the Company’s business. The material risks and uncertainties that management believes affect the Company are described below. Before making an investment decision, you should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below together with all of the other information included or incorporated by reference in this report. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones facing the Company. Additional risks and uncertainties that management is not aware of or focused on, or that management currently deems immaterial, may also impair the Company’s business operations. This report is qualified in its entirety by these risk factors.

If any of the following risks adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations, the value of the parent company’s common shares could decline significantly and you could lose all or part of your investment.

RISKS RELATED TO THE COMPANY’S BUSINESS

The Company’s Business May Be Adversely Affected by Conditions in the Financial Markets and Economic Conditions Generally

From December 2007 through June 2009, the United States experienced a recession and a slowing of economic activity. Business activity across a wide range of industries and regions was greatly reduced. The real estate sector, and the related segments of the construction business sector, were particularly severely affected. Local governments and many businesses are in serious difficulty, due to the lack of consumer spending and the lack of liquidity in the credit markets. Unemployment has increased significantly.

Since mid-2007, and particularly during the second half of 2008 and the first half of 2009, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally were materially and adversely affected by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. This was initially triggered by declines in home prices and the values of subprime mortgages, but spread to all mortgage and real estate asset classes, to leveraged bank loans and to nearly all asset classes, including equities.

The U.S. financial system has stabilized, but internationally, the weakness of certain foreign banks and the increasing danger of sovereign defaults has led to continuing high levels of uncertainty and volatility in the international financial markets.

Although economic conditions have begun to improve, certain sectors, such as real estate, remain weak and unemployment remains high. Despite the actions of the US Government and the Federal Reserve Board, both with respect to monetary policy, fiscal policy, and increased regulations meant to restore investor confidence, the overall business environment in 2010 was adverse for many households and businesses in the United States and worldwide.

The Company’s financial performance generally, and in particular the ability of borrowers to pay interest on and repay the principal of outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, is highly dependent upon the business environment in the markets where the Company operates, in the New York metropolitan area and in the United States as a whole. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, economic growth, efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence, and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by: declines in

PAGE 17


economic growth, business activity, or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; increases in inflation or interest rates; natural disasters; or a combination of these or other factors. The business environment in the New York metropolitan area, the United States and worldwide has been improving throughout 2010, but there can be no assurance that these conditions will continue to improve in the near term. A slowing of improvement or a return to deteriorating economic conditions could adversely affect the credit quality of the Company’s loans, results of operations and financial condition.

Improvements in Economic Indicators Disproportionately Affecting the Financial Services Industry May Lag Improvements in the General Economy

The improvement of certain economic indicators, such as unemployment and real estate asset values and rents, may nevertheless continue to lag behind the overall economy. These economic indicators typically affect certain industries, such as real estate and financial services, more significantly. For example, improvements in commercial real estate fundamentals typically lag broad economic recovery by 12 to 18 months. The Company’s clients include entities active in these industries. Furthermore, financial services companies with a substantial lending business are dependent upon the ability of their borrowers to make debt service payments on loans. Should unemployment or real estate asset values fail to recover for an extended period of time, the Company could be adversely affected.

The Company Is Subject to Interest Rate Risk

The Company’s earnings and cash flows are largely dependent upon its net interest income. Net interest income is the difference between interest income earned on interest-earning assets such as loans and securities and interest expense paid on interest-bearing liabilities such as deposits and borrowed funds. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies and, in particular, the Federal Open Market Committee. Changes in monetary policy, including changes in interest rates, could influence not only the interest the Company receives on loans and securities and the amount of interest it pays on deposits and borrowings, but such changes could also affect (i) the Company’s ability to originate loans and obtain deposits, (ii) the fair value of the Company’s financial assets and liabilities, and (iii) the average duration of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities portfolio. If the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings increase at a faster rate than the interest rates received on loans and other investments, the Company’s net interest income, and therefore earnings, could be adversely affected. Earnings could also be adversely affected if the interest rates received on loans and other investments fall more quickly than the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings.

Although management believes it has implemented effective asset and liability management strategies to reduce the potential effects of changes in interest rates on the Company’s results of operations, any substantial, unexpected, prolonged change in market interest rates could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. For further discussion related to the Company’s management of interest rate risk, see “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” beginning on page 52 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

The Company Is Subject to Lending Risk

There are inherent risks associated with the Company’s lending activities. These risks include, among other things, the impact of changes in interest rates and changes in the economic conditions in the markets where the Company operates as well as those throughout the United States. Increases in interest rates and/or a return to weakening economic conditions could adversely impact the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans or the value of the collateral securing these loans. The Company is also subject to various laws and regulations that affect its lending activities. Failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations could subject the Company to regulatory enforcement action that could result in the assessment of significant civil money penalties against the Company. In addition, under various laws and regulations relating to mortgage lending and terms of various agreements the Company is a party to, the Company may be required to repurchase loans or indemnify loan purchasers as a result of breaches of representations and warranties, borrower fraud, or certain borrower defaults.

As of December 31, 2010, approximately 67.0% of the Company’s loan portfolio consisted of commercial and industrial, factored receivables, construction and commercial real estate loans. These types of loans are generally viewed as having more risk of default than residential real estate loans or consumer loans. These types of loans are also typically larger than residential real estate loans and consumer loans. Because the Company’s loan portfolio contains a significant number of commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of one or a few of these loans could cause a significant increase in non-performing loans. An increase in non-performing loans could result in a net loss of earnings from these loans, an increase in the provision for loan losses and an increase in loan charge-offs, all of which could have a

PAGE 18


material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. Further, if repurchase and indemnity demands with respect to the Company’s loan portfolio increase, its liquidity, results of operations and financial condition will be adversely affected. For further discussion related to commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans, see “Loan Portfolio” beginning on page 43 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

The Company’s Allowance for Loan Losses May Be Insufficient

The Company maintains an allowance for loan losses, which is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, that represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that have been incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The level of the allowance reflects management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations; specific credit risks; loan loss experience; current loan portfolio quality; present economic, political and regulatory conditions and unidentified losses inherent in the current loan portfolio. The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires the Company to make significant estimates of current credit risks and future trends, all of which may undergo material changes. Continuing deterioration of economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside the Company’s control, may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses and may require an increase in the provision for loan losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based on judgments different than those of management. In addition, if charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for loan losses, the Company will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for loan losses. Any increases in the allowance for loan losses will result in a decrease in net income and, possibly, capital, and may have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. For further discussion related to the Company’s process for determining the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses, see “Asset Quality” beginning on page 44 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

The Company May Not Be Able to Meet the Cash Flow Requirements of Its Depositors and Borrowers or Meet Its Operating Cash Needs to Fund Corporate Expansion and Other Activities

Liquidity is the ability to meet cash flow needs on a timely basis at a reasonable cost. The liquidity of the bank is used to make loans and leases and to repay deposit liabilities as they become due or are demanded by customers. Liquidity policies and limits are established by the board of directors. The overall liquidity position of the bank and the parent company are regularly monitored to ensure that various alternative strategies exist to cover unanticipated events that could affect liquidity. Funding sources include Federal funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements and non-core deposits. The bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York, which provides funding through advances to members that are collateralized with mortgage-related assets. The Company maintains a portfolio of securities that can be used as a secondary source of liquidity. The bank also can borrow through the Federal Reserve Bank’s discount window.

If the Company is unable to access any of these funding sources when needed, we might be unable to meet customers’ needs, which could adversely impact our financial condition, results of operations, cash flows, and level of regulatory-qualifying capital. For further discussion, see “Liquidity Risk” beginning on page 53 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”

The Parent Company Relies on Dividends from Its Subsidiaries

The parent company is a separate and distinct legal entity from its subsidiaries. It receives dividends from its subsidiaries. These dividends are the principal source of funds to pay dividends on the parent company’s common stock and interest and principal on its debt. Various federal and/or state laws and regulations limit the amount of dividends that the bank and certain non-bank subsidiaries may pay to the parent company. Also, the parent company’s right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors. In the event the bank is unable to pay dividends to the parent company, the parent company may not be able to service debt, pay obligations or pay dividends on the parent company’s common stock. The inability of the parent company to receive dividends from the bank could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. See “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” on pages 3–15 and Note 18 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

PAGE 19


The Company May Need to Raise Additional Capital in the Future and Such Capital May Not Be Available When Needed or at All

The Company may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide it with sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet its commitments and business needs, particularly if its asset quality or earnings were to deteriorate significantly. The Company’s ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on, among other things, conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside of the Company’s control, and the Company’s financial performance. Economic conditions and the loss of confidence in financial institutions may increase the Company’s cost of funding and limit access to certain customary sources of capital, including inter-bank borrowings, repurchase agreements and borrowings from the Federal Reserve Bank’s discount window.

The Company cannot assure that such capital will be available on acceptable terms or at all. Any occurrence that may limit the Company’s access to the capital markets, such as a decline in the confidence of debt purchasers, depositors of the bank or counterparties participating in the capital markets, or a downgrade of the parent company or the bank’s ratings, may adversely affect the Company’s capital costs and its ability to raise capital and, in turn, its liquidity. Moreover, if the Company needs to raise capital in the future, it may have to do so when many other financial institutions are also seeking to raise capital and would have to compete with those institutions for investors. An inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when needed could have a materially adverse effect on the Company’s businesses, financial condition and results of operations.

The Parent Company’s Agreements with the U.S. Treasury Impose Restrictions and Obligations on Us that Limit Our Ability to Increase Dividends, Repurchase the Parent Company’s Common Shares or Preferred Shares and Access the Equity Capital Markets

In December 2008, the parent company issued preferred shares and a warrant to purchase our common shares to the U.S. Treasury as part of its TARP Capital Purchase Program. Prior to December 23, 2011, unless we have redeemed all the preferred shares or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all the preferred shares to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to, among other things, increase the dividend on our common shares or repurchase our common shares or other preferred shares (with certain exceptions, including the repurchase of our common shares to offset share dilution from equity-based employee compensation awards). The parent company has also granted registration rights and offering facilitation rights to the U.S. Treasury pursuant to which the parent company has agreed to lock-up periods during which we would be unable to issue equity securities. In addition, unless we are able to redeem the preferred stock prior to December 24, 2013, the dividends on the preferred stock will increase substantially, from 5% to 9%. Depending on market conditions at the time, this increase in dividends could significantly impact our liquidity.

Negative Perceptions Associated with the Company’s Continued Participation in the U.S. Treasury’s Capital Purchase Program May Adversely Affect Its Ability to Retain Customers, Attract Investors and Compete for New Business Opportunities

A number of financial institutions which participated in the TARP Capital Purchase Program have received approval from the U.S. Treasury to exit the program. These institutions have, or are in the process of, repurchasing the preferred stock and repurchasing or auctioning the warrant issued to the U.S. Treasury as part of the program. The Company has not yet requested the U.S. Treasury’s approval to repurchase the preferred stock and warrant from the U.S. Treasury. In order to repurchase one or both securities, in whole or in part, the Company must establish that it has satisfied all of the conditions to repurchase and must obtain the approval of the U.S. Treasury. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to repurchase these securities from the U.S. Treasury. The Company’s customers, employees and counter-parties in its current and future business relationships may draw negative implications regarding the strength of the Company as a financial institution based on its continued participation in the program following the exit of one or more of its competitors or other financial institutions. Any such negative perceptions may impair the Company’s ability to effectively compete with other financial institutions for business or to retain high performing employees. If this were to occur, the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected, perhaps materially.

The Company Is Subject to a Variety of Operational Risks, Including Reputational Risk, Legal and Compliance Risk, the Risk of Fraud or Theft by Employees or Outsiders

The Company is exposed to many types of operational risks, including reputational risk, legal and compliance risk, the risk of fraud or theft by employees or outsiders, unauthorized transactions by employees or operational errors, including clerical or record-keeping errors or those resulting from faulty or disabled computer or telecommunications systems. Negative public opinion can result from its actual or alleged conduct in any number of activities, including lending practices, corporate governance and acquisitions and from actions taken by government regulators and community organizations in response to those activities. Negative public opinion can adversely affect its ability to attract and keep customers and can expose the Company to litigation and regulatory action.

PAGE 20


Actual or alleged conduct by the Company can result in negative public opinion about its other business. Negative public opinion could also affect its credit ratings, which are important to its access to unsecured wholesale borrowings.

Because the nature of the financial services business involves a high volume of transactions, certain errors may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and successfully rectified. The Company’s necessary dependence upon automated systems to record and process its transaction volume may further increase the risk that technical flaws or employee tampering or manipulation of those systems will result in losses that are difficult to detect. The Company also may be subject to disruptions of its operating systems arising from events that are wholly or partially beyond its control (for example, computer viruses or electrical or telecommunications outages), which may give rise to disruption of service to customers and to financial loss or liability. The Company is further exposed to the risk that its external vendors may be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations (or will be subject to the same risk of fraud or operational errors by their respective employees as the Company is) and to the risk that its (or its vendors’) business continuity and data security systems prove to be inadequate. The occurrence of any of these risks could result in a diminished ability of the Company to operate its business, potential liability to clients, reputational damage and regulatory intervention, which could adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations, perhaps materially.

The Company Relies on Other Companies to Provide Key Components of Its Business Infrastructure.

Third parties provide key components of the Company’s business infrastructure, for example, system support, and Internet connections and network access. While the Company has selected these third party vendors carefully, it does not control their actions. Any problems caused by these third parties, including those resulting from their failure to provide services for any reason or their poor performance of services, could adversely affect its ability to deliver products and services to its customers and otherwise conduct its business. Replacing these third party vendors could also entail significant delay and expense.

The Company Is Subject to Environmental Liability Risk Associated with Lending Activities

A portion of the Company’s loan portfolio is secured by real property. During the ordinary course of business, the Company may foreclose on and take title to properties securing certain loans. In doing so, there is a risk that hazardous or toxic substances could be found on these properties. If hazardous or toxic substances are found, the Company may be liable for remediation costs, as well as for personal injury and property damage. Environmental laws may require the Company to incur substantial expense and may materially reduce the affected property’s value or limit the Company’s ability to use or sell the affected property. Future laws or more stringent interpretations or enforcement policies with respect to existing laws may increase the Company’s exposure to environmental liability. Although the Company has policies and procedures to perform an environmental review before initiating any foreclosure action on real property, these reviews may not be sufficient to detect all potential environmental hazards. The remediation costs and any other financial liabilities associated with an environmental hazard could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company’s Profitability Depends Significantly on Local and Overall Economic Conditions

The Company’s success depends significantly on the economic conditions of the communities it serves and the general economic conditions of the United States. The Company has operations in New York City and the New York metropolitan area, and conducts business in Virginia and other mid-Atlantic states, and throughout the United States. The economic conditions in these areas and throughout the United States have a significant impact on the demand for the Company’s products and services as well as the ability of the Company’s customers to repay loans, the value of the collateral securing loans and the stability of the Company’s deposit funding sources. Poor economic conditions, whether caused by recession, inflation, unemployment, changes in securities markets, acts of terrorism, outbreak of hostilities or other international or domestic occurrences, acts of God or other factors could impact these local economic conditions and, in turn, have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company May Be Adversely Affected by the Soundness of Other Financial Institutions

Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. The Company has exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely executes transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including commercial banks, brokers and dealers, investment banks, and other institutional clients. Many of these transactions expose the Company to credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, the Company’s credit risk may be exacerbated when the collateral held by the Company cannot be realized upon or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the credit, or

PAGE 21


derivative, if any, exposure due to the Company. Any such losses could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

Severe Weather, Natural Disasters or Other Acts of God, Acts of War or Terrorism and Other External Events Could Significantly Impact the Company’s Business

Severe weather, natural disasters or other acts of God, acts of war or terrorism and other adverse external events could have a significant impact on the Company’s ability to conduct business. Such events could affect the stability of the Company’s deposit base, impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans, impair the value of collateral securing loans, cause significant property damage, result in loss of revenue and/or cause the Company to incur additional expenses. Although management has established disaster recovery policies and procedures, the occurrence of any such event could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company Operates in a Highly Competitive Industry and Market Area

The Company faces substantial competition in all areas of its operations from a variety of different competitors, many of which are larger and may have more financial resources. Such competitors primarily include national, regional, and community banks within the various markets the Company operates. Additionally, various out-of-state banks have entered the market areas in which the Company currently operates. The Company also faces competition from many other types of financial institutions, including, without limitation, savings and loan associations, credit unions, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance companies, factoring companies and other financial intermediaries. The financial services industry could become even more competitive as a result of legislative, regulatory and technological changes and continued consolidation. Also, technology and other changes have lowered barriers to entry and made it possible for non-banks to offer products and services traditionally provided by banks. For example, consumers can maintain funds that would have historically been held as bank deposits in brokerage accounts or mutual funds. Consumers can also complete transactions such as paying bills and/or transferring funds directly without the assistance of banks. The process of eliminating banks as intermediaries, known as “disintermediation,” could result in the loss of fee income, as well as the loss of customer deposits and the related income generated from those deposits. Many of the Company’s competitors have fewer regulatory constraints and may have lower cost structures. Additionally, due to their size, many competitors may be able to achieve economies of scale and, as a result, may offer a broader range of products and services as well as better pricing for those products and services than the Company does.

The Company’s ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among other things:

 

 

The ability to develop, maintain and build upon customer relationships based on top quality service, high ethical standards and safe, sound assets.

 

 

The ability to expand the Company’s market position.

 

 

The scope, relevance and pricing of products and services offered to meet customer needs and demands.

 

 

The rate at which the Company introduces new products and services relative to its competitors.

 

 

Customer satisfaction with the Company’s level of service.

 

 

Industry and general economic trends.

Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken the Company’s competitive position, which could adversely affect the Company’s growth and profitability, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company Is Subject to Extensive Government Regulation and Supervision

The Company, primarily through the parent company and the bank and certain non-bank subsidiaries, is subject to extensive federal and state regulation and supervision. Banking regulations are primarily intended to protect depositors’ funds, federal deposit insurance funds and the banking system as a whole, not shareholders. These regulations affect the Company’s lending practices, capital structure, investment practices, dividend policy and growth, among other things. Congress and federal regulatory agencies continually review banking laws, regulations and policies for possible changes. The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted in July 2010, instituted major changes to the banking and financial institutions’ regulatory regimes in the near future in light of the recent performance of and government intervention in the financial services sector. Other changes to statutes, regulations or regulatory policies, including changes in interpretation or implementation of statutes, regulations or policies, could affect the Company in substantial and unpredictable ways. Such changes could subject the Company to additional costs, limit the types of financial services and products the Company may offer and/or increase the ability of non-banks to offer competing financial services and products, among other things. Failure to comply with laws, regulations or policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil money penalties and/or reputation damage, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. While the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent any such violations, there can be no

PAGE 22


assurance that such violations will not occur. See “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” on pages 3–15.

Increases in FDIC Insurance Premiums May Adversely Affect the Company’s Earnings

Since 2008, higher levels of bank failures have dramatically increased resolution costs of the FDIC and depleted the Deposit Insurance Fund. In addition, the FDIC instituted two temporary programs to further insure customer deposits at FDIC insured banks: deposit accounts are currently insured up to $250,000 per customer (up from $100,000) and non-interest bearing transactional accounts at institutions participating in the Transaction Account Guarantee Program are currently fully insured (unlimited coverage). These programs have placed additional stress on the Deposit Insurance Fund.

In order to maintain a strong funding position and restore reserve ratios of the Deposit Insurance Fund, the FDIC has increased assessment rates of insured institutions. In addition, on November 12, 2009, the FDIC adopted a rule requiring banks to prepay three years’ worth of premiums to replenish the depleted fund.

The Company is generally unable to control the amount of premiums that it is required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional bank or financial institution failures the Company may be required to pay even higher FDIC premiums than the recently increased levels. Such increases and any future increases or required prepayments of FDIC insurance premiums may adversely impact its earnings.

The Company’s Controls and Procedures May Fail or Be Circumvented

The Company’s internal controls, disclosure controls and procedures, and corporate governance policies and procedures can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of the Company’s controls and procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Company May Be Subject to a Higher Effective Tax Rate if Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. Fails to Qualify as a Real Estate Investment Trust (“REIT”)

Sterling Real Estate Holding Company Inc. (“SREHC”) operates as a REIT for federal income tax purposes. SREHC was established to acquire, hold and manage mortgage assets and other authorized investments to generate net income for distribution to its shareholders.

For an entity to qualify as a REIT, it must satisfy the following six asset tests under the Internal Revenue Code each quarter: (1) 75% of the value of the REIT’s total assets must consist of real estate assets, cash and cash items, and government securities; (2) not more than 25% of the value of the REIT’s total assets may consist of securities, other than those includible under the 75% test; (3) not more than 5% of the value of its total assets may consist of securities of any one issuer, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; (4) not more than 10% of the outstanding voting power of any one issuer may be held, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; (5) not more than 10% of the total value of the outstanding securities of any one issuer may be held, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; and (6) a REIT cannot own securities in one or more taxable REIT subsidiaries which comprise more than 25% of its total assets. At December 31, 2010, SREHC met all six quarterly asset tests.

Also, a REIT must satisfy the following two gross income tests each year: (1) 75% of its gross income must be from qualifying income closely connected with real estate activities; and (2) 95% of its gross income must be derived from sources qualifying for the 75% test plus dividends, interest, and gains from the sale of securities. In addition, a REIT must distribute at least 90% of its taxable income for the taxable year, excluding any net capital gains, to maintain its non-taxable status for federal income tax purposes. For 2010, SREHC had met the two annual income tests and the distribution test.

If SREHC fails to meet any of the required provisions and, therefore, does not qualify to be a REIT, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.

The Company Would Be Subject to a Higher Effective Tax Rate if Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. Is Required to Be Included in a New York Combined Return

New York State tax law generally requires a REIT that is majority owned by a New York State bank to be included in the bank’s combined New York State tax return. The Company believes that it qualifies for the small-bank exception to this rule. If, contrary to this belief, Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. were required to be included in the Company’s New York State combined tax return, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.

Under the small-bank exception, dividends received by the bank from SREHC, a real estate investment trust, are subject to a 60% dividends-received deduction, which results in only 40% of the dividends being subject to New York State tax. Currently, the New York City banking corporation tax operates in the same manner in this respect. The possible reform of the New York State franchise and banking corporation tax laws mentioned below could require SREHC to file a combined New

PAGE 23


York State return with the Company and substantially eliminate the benefit of the 60% dividends-received deduction by causing generally all of SREHC’s income to be subject to New York State tax as part of the Company’s combined return.

Possible New York State Legislative Changes May Negatively Affect the Amount of Taxes We Pay in Future Years

In 2009 and 2010, the New York State Department of Taxation and Finance developed a detailed proposal to reform the New York State corporate franchise and banking laws. If that released proposal were enacted, it would substantially alter how the Company and the bank are taxed in New York State and could materially increase their combined effective New York State tax rate. In particular, that proposal would require SREHC to file a combined New York State return with the Company and substantially eliminate the benefit of the 60% dividends-received deduction by causing generally all of SREHC’s income to be subject to New York State tax as part of the Company’s combined return.

It is not possible to predict whether any tax reform legislation will actually be proposed in the New York State legislature, whether any such legislation would be enacted this year or any subsequent year, how any enacted legislation would differ from the current law or the 2010 proposal released by the Department of Taxation and Finance, and how any such legislative changes would impact the Company and the bank’s effective New York State tax rate. It is also uncertain at this time whether there would be any similar changes made to the New York City banking corporation tax.

The Recent Repeal of Federal Prohibitions on Payment of Interest on Demand Deposits Could Increase the Company’s Interest Expense.

All federal prohibitions on the ability of financial institutions to pay interest on demand deposit accounts were repealed as part of the Dodd-Frank Act. As a result, beginning on July 21, 2011, financial institutions could commence offering interest on demand deposits to compete for clients. The Company does not yet know what interest rates other institutions may offer. The Company’s interest expense will increase and its net interest margin will decrease if it begins offering interest on demand deposits to attract additional customers or maintain current customers, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

New Lines of Business or New Products and Services May Subject the Company to Additional Risks

The Company may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts, particularly in instances where the markets are not fully developed. In developing and marketing new lines of business and/or new products and services, the Company may invest significant time and resources. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new products or services may not be achieved and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible. External factors, such as compliance with regulations, competitive alternatives, and shifting market preferences, may also impact the successful implementation of a new line of business or a new product or service. Furthermore, any new line of business and/or new product or service could have a significant impact on the effectiveness of the Company’s system of internal controls. Failure to manage these risks successfully in the development and implementation of new lines of business or new products or services could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

Potential Acquisitions May Disrupt the Company’s Business and Dilute Shareholder Value

The Company seeks merger or acquisition partners that are compatible and have experienced management and possess either significant market presence or have potential for improved profitability through financial management, economies of scale or expanded services. Acquiring other banks, businesses, or branches involves various risks commonly associated with acquisitions, including, among other things:

 

 

Potential exposure to unknown or contingent liabilities of the target company.

 

 

Exposure to potential asset quality issues of the target company.

 

 

Difficulty and expense of integrating the operations and personnel of the target company.

 

 

Potential disruption to the Company’s business.

 

 

Potential diversion of the Company’s management time and attention.

 

 

The possible loss of key employees and customers of the target company.

 

 

Difficulty in estimating the value of the target company.

 

 

Potential changes in banking or tax laws or regulations that may affect the target company.

The Company regularly evaluates merger and acquisition opportunities and conducts due diligence activities related to possible transactions with other financial institutions and financial services companies. As a result, merger or acquisition discussions and, in some cases, negotiations may take place and future mergers or acquisitions involving cash, debt or equity securities may occur at any time. Acquisitions typically

PAGE 24


involve the payment of a premium over book and market values, and, therefore, some dilution of the Company’s tangible book value and net income per common share may occur in connection with any future transaction. Furthermore, failure to realize the expected revenue increases, cost savings, increases in geographic or product presence, and/or other projected benefits from an acquisition could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company May Not Be Able to Attract and Retain Skilled People

The Company’s success depends, in large part, on its ability to attract and retain key people. Competition for the best people in most activities engaged in by the Company can be intense, and the Company may not be able to hire people or to retain them. The unexpected loss of services of one or more of the Company’s key personnel could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business because of their skills, knowledge of the Company’s market, years of industry experience and the difficulty of promptly finding qualified replacement personnel. The Company has employment agreements with two of its senior officers.

Because the Company has not yet repurchased the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program investment, it remains subject to the restrictions on incentive compensation contained in the ARRA. On June 10, 2009, the U.S. Treasury released its interim final rule implementing the provisions of the ARRA and limiting the compensation practices at institutions in which the U.S. Treasury is invested. Financial institutions which have repurchased the U.S. Treasury’s investment are relieved of the restrictions imposed by the ARRA and its implementing regulations. Due to these restrictions, the Company may not be able to successfully compete with financial institutions that have repurchased the U.S. Treasury’s investment to retain and attract high performing employees. If this were to occur, the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected, perhaps materially.

The Company’s Information Systems May Experience an Interruption or Breach in Security

The Company relies heavily on communications and information systems to conduct its business. Any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems could result in failures or disruptions in the Company’s customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit, loan and other systems. While the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of its information systems, there can be no assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed. The occurrence of any failures, interruptions or security breaches of the Company’s information systems could damage the Company’s reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject the Company to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose the Company to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s reputation, financial condition and results of operations.

The Company Depends on the Accuracy and Completeness of Information About Customers and Counterparties

In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions, the Company may rely on information furnished by or on behalf of customers and counterparties, including financial statements, credit reports and other financial information. The Company may also rely on representations of those customers, counterparties or other third parties, such as independent auditors, as to the accuracy and completeness of that information. Reliance on inaccurate or misleading financial statements, credit reports or other financial information could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business and, in turn, the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company Continually Encounters Technological Change

The financial services industry is continually undergoing rapid technological change with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. The Company’s future success depends, in part, upon its ability to address the needs of customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands, as well as to create additional efficiencies in the Company’s operations. Many of the Company’s competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. The Company may not be able to implement effectively new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to its customers. Failure to keep pace successfully with technological change affecting the financial services industry could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business and, in turn, the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company Is Subject to Claims and Litigation Pertaining to Fiduciary Responsibility and Lender Liability

From time to time, customers make claims and take legal action pertaining to the Company’s performance of its fiduciary responsibilities. Whether customer claims and legal action related to the Company’s performance of its fiduciary

PAGE 25


responsibilities are founded or unfounded, if such claims and legal actions are not resolved in a manner favorable to the Company they may result in significant financial liability and/or adversely affect the market perception of the Company and its products and services as well as impact customer demand for those products and services. Any fiduciary liability or reputation damage could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, in recent years, a number of judicial decisions have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories, collectively termed “lender liability.” Generally, lender liability is founded on the premise that a lender has either violated a duty, whether implied or contractual, of good faith and fair dealing owed to the borrower or has assumed a degree of control over the borrower resulting in the creation of a fiduciary duty owed to the borrower or its other creditors or shareholders. Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against the Company or its subsidiaries could materially adversely affect its business, financial condition or results of operations and/or cause significant harm to its reputation.

The Company’s Reported Financial Results Depend on Management’s Selection of Accounting Methods and Certain Assumptions and Estimates

The Company’s accounting policies and methods are fundamental to the methods by which the Company records and reports its financial condition and results of operations. Its management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with generally accepted accounting principles and reflect management’s judgment of the most appropriate manner to report its financial condition and results. In some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more alternatives, any of which may be reasonable under the circumstances, yet may result in its reporting materially different results than would have been reported under a different alternative.

Certain accounting policies are critical to presenting its financial condition and results. They require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain. Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions or estimates. These critical accounting policies include: the allowance for credit losses; the determination of fair value for financial instruments; the valuation of goodwill and other intangible assets; the accounting for pension and post-retirement benefits and the accounting for income taxes. Because of the uncertainty of estimates involved in these matters, the Company may be required to do one or more of the following: significantly increase the allowance for credit losses and/or sustain credit losses that are significantly higher than the reserve provided; recognize significant impairment on its goodwill and other intangible asset balances; or significantly increase its accrued tax liability.

Changes in the Company’s Accounting Policies or in Accounting Standards Could Materially Affect How the Company Reports Its Financial Results and Condition

From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) and SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of the Company’s financial statements. These changes can be hard to predict and can materially impact how the Company records and reports its financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, the Company could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in the Company restating prior period financial statements.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE PARENT COMPANY’S COMMON SHARES

The Parent Company’s Share Price Can Be Volatile

Share price volatility may make it more difficult to resell the parent company’s common shares when desired and at an attractive price. The parent company’s share price can fluctuate significantly in response to a variety of factors, including, among other factors:

 

 

Actual or anticipated variations in quarterly results of operations.

 

 

Recommendations by securities analysts.

 

 

Expectation of or actual equity dilution.

 

 

Operating and share price performance of other companies that investors deem comparable to the Company.

 

 

News reports relating to trends, concerns and other issues in the financial services industry.

 

 

Perceptions in the marketplace regarding the Company and/or its competitors.

 

 

New technology used, or services offered, by competitors.

 

 

Significant acquisitions or business combinations, strategic partnerships, joint ventures or capital commitments by or involving the Company or its competitors.

 

 

Failure to integrate acquisitions or realize anticipated benefits from acquisitions.

 

 

Changes in government regulation.

 

 

Geopolitical conditions such as acts or threats of terrorism or military conflicts.

PAGE 26


General market fluctuations, industry factors and general economic and political conditions and events, such as economic slowdowns or recessions, interest rate changes or credit loss trends, could also cause the parent company’s share price to decrease regardless of operating results.

The Trading Volume in the Parent Company’s Common Shares Is Less Than That of Other Larger Financial Services Companies

Although the parent company’s common shares are listed for trading on the NYSE, the trading volume in its common shares is less than that of other larger financial services companies. A public trading market having the desired characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends on the presence in the marketplace of willing buyers and sellers of the parent company’s common shares at any given time. This presence depends on the individual decisions of investors and general economic and market conditions over which the Company has no control. Given the trading volume of the parent company’s common shares, significant sales of the parent company’s common shares, or the expectation of these sales, could cause the parent company’s share price to fall.

An Investment in the Parent Company’s Common Shares Is Not an Insured Deposit

The parent company’s common shares are not bank deposits and, therefore, are not insured against loss by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. Investment in the parent company’s common shares are inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk Factors” section and elsewhere in this report and is subject to the same market forces that affect the price of common shares in any company. As a result, if you acquire the parent company’s common shares, you may lose some or all of your investment.

The Parent Company’s Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws as Well as Certain Banking Laws May Have an Anti-Takeover Effect

Provisions of the parent company’s certificate of incorporation and by-laws, and federal banking laws, including regulatory approval requirements, could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire the parent company, even if doing so would be perceived to be beneficial to the parent company’s shareholders. The combination of these provisions effectively inhibits a non-negotiated merger or other business combination, which, in turn, could adversely affect the market price of the parent company’s common shares.

The Parent Company May Not Pay Dividends on Its Common Shares

Holders of shares of the parent company’s common shares are only entitled to receive such dividends as its board of directors may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Although the parent company has historically declared cash dividends on its common shares, it is not required to do so and may reduce or eliminate its common share dividend in the future. This could adversely affect the market price of its common shares. Also, participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program limits its ability to increase its dividend or to repurchase its common shares for so long as any securities issued under such program remain outstanding.

Future Issuances of Additional Common Shares or Other Equity Securities Could Result in Dilution of Ownership of the Parent Company’s Existing Shareholders

The parent company may from time to time explore capital raising opportunities and may determine to issue additional common shares or other equity securities to increase its capital, support growth, or to make acquisitions. We intend to take advantage of favorable market conditions to increase our capital and, subject to regulatory approvals, seek to repurchase our Series A Preferred Shares, separately or together, with the warrant to purchase common shares held by the U.S. Treasury. Further, the parent company may issue stock options or other stock grants to retain and motivate its employees. These issuances of equity securities could dilute the voting and economic interests of its existing shareholders.

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None.

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

The principal office of the Company occupies one floor at 650 Fifth Avenue, New York, N.Y., consisting of approximately 14,400 square feet. The lease for this office expires April 30, 2016. Rental commitments to the expiration date approximate $4.7 million.

At December 31, 2010, the bank also maintains operating leases for ten branch offices, the International Banking Facility, and additional space in New York City, Nassau, Suffolk and Westchester counties (New York) with an aggregate of approximately 139 thousand square feet. Effective in 2011, certain lease agreements terminate and the bank has entered into new agreements for additional space, bringing the amount of space committed to an aggregate of approximately 133 thousand square feet. The aggregate office rental commitments for these premises, including the new space under lease in 2011, approximates $45.0 million. These leases have expiration dates ranging from 2011 through 2025 with varying renewal options. The bank owns free and clear (not subject to a mortgage) a building in which it maintains a branch located in Forest Hills, Queens, N.Y.

PAGE 27


ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In the normal course of business there are various legal proceedings pending against the Company. Management, after consulting with counsel, is of the opinion that there should be no material liability with respect to such proceedings and accordingly no provision has been made in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

No matter was submitted to a vote of security holders in the fourth quarter of the fiscal year covered by this report.

EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

This table sets forth information regarding the parent company’s executive officers:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name of Executive

Title

 

Age

 

Held Executive
Office Since







Louis J. Cappelli

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, Director

 

80

 

1967

John C. Millman

President, Director

 

68

 

1986

John W. Tietjen

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 

66

 

1989

Howard M. Applebaum

Senior Vice President

 

52

 

2002

Eliot S. Robinson

Executive Vice President of Sterling National Bank

 

68

 

1998

All executive officers who are employees of the parent company are elected annually by the Board of Directors and serve at the pleasure of the Board. The executive officer who is not an employee of the parent company is elected annually by, and serves at the pleasure of, the Board of Directors of the bank. There are no arrangements or understandings between any of the foregoing executive officers and any other person or persons pursuant to which he was selected as an executive officer.


The Company’s 2010 Domestic Company Section 303A Annual CEO Certification was filed (without qualifications) with the NYSE. The certifications under Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act are filed as exhibits to this annual report on Form 10-K.

PART II

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

The parent company’s common shares are traded on the NYSE under the symbol STL. Information regarding the quarterly prices of the common shares is presented in Note 28 on page 113. Information regarding the average common shares outstanding and dividends per common share is presented in the Consolidated Statements of Income on page 59. Information regarding legal restrictions on the ability of the bank to pay dividends is presented in Note 18 on page 93. Although such restrictions do not apply to the payment of dividends by the parent company to its shareholders, such dividends may be limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital under the risk-based capital regulations described in Note 24 beginning on page 107. As of February 14, 2011, there were 1,273 shareholders of record of our common shares.

Pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, until the earliest of December 23, 2011, the redemption of all of the Series A Preferred Shares or transfer by the U.S. Treasury of all of the Series A Preferred shares to third parties, the parent company must obtain the consent of the U.S. Treasury to raise the dividend on our common shares or to repurchase any common shares or other preferred shares, with certain exceptions (including repurchases of our common shares under our share repurchase program to offset dilution from equity-based compensation).

PAGE 28


During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, the following dividends were declared on our common shares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash Dividends Per Share

 

2010

 

2009

 







First Quarter

 

$

0.09

 

$

0.19

 

Second Quarter

 

 

0.09

 

 

0.19

 

Third Quarter

 

 

0.09

 

 

0.09

 

Fourth Quarter

 

 

0.09

 

 

0.09

 

 

 






 

Total

 

$

0.36

 

$

0.56

 

 

 






 

The Board of Directors initially authorized the repurchase of common shares in 1997 and since then has approved increases in the number of common shares that the parent company is authorized to repurchase. The latest increase was announced on February 15, 2007, when the Board of Directors increased the Company’s authority to repurchase common shares by an additional 800,000 shares. This increased the Company’s authority to repurchase shares to approximately 933,000 common shares.

Under its share repurchase program, the Company buys back common shares from time to time. The Company did not repurchase any of its common shares during the fourth quarter of 2010. At December 31, 2010, the maximum number of shares that may yet be repurchased under the share repurchase program was 870,963.

For information regarding securities authorized for issuance under the Company’s equity compensation plan, see Item 12 on page 119. The following performance graph compares for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 and 2010 (a) the yearly cumulative total shareholder return (i.e., the change in share price plus the cumulative amount of dividends, assuming dividend reinvestment, divided by the initial share price, expressed as a percentage) on Sterling’s common shares, with (b) the cumulative total return of the Standard & Poor’s 500 Stock Index, with (c) the cumulative total return on the KBW Regional Banks Index (a market-capitalization weighted bank-stock index), and with (d) the cumulative total return on the KBW 50 index (a market-capitalization weighted bank-stock index):

(LINE GRAPH)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 















 

 

12/05

 

12/06

 

12/07

 

12/08

 

12/09

 

12/10

 















Sterling Bancorp

 

 

100

 

 

103.87

 

 

75.62

 

 

82.26

 

 

44.84

 

 

68.31

 

S&P 500

 

 

100

 

 

115.80

 

 

122.16

 

 

79.96

 

 

97.33

 

 

111.99

 

KBW Regional Banks

 

 

100

 

 

108.56

 

 

84.71

 

 

68.99

 

 

53.72

 

 

64.68

 

KBW 50

 

 

100

 

 

119.20

 

 

91.76

 

 

50.00

 

 

50.57

 

 

*

 

*Index discontinued by KBW as of 12/31/09.

PAGE 29


ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The information appears on page 31. All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The information appears on pages 32–56 and supplementary quarterly data appears in Note 28 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto.

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

The information appears on pages 52–55 under the caption “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT.” All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.

PAGE 30


Sterling Bancorp
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA[1]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(dollars in thousands except per share data)

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

 













SUMMARY OF OPERATIONS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total interest income

 

$

97,190

 

$

105,920

 

$

118,071

 

$

121,433

 

$

116,611

 

Total interest expense

 

 

15,583

 

 

19,295

 

 

33,388

 

 

47,560

 

 

42,021

 

Net interest income

 

 

81,607

 

 

86,625

 

 

84,683

 

 

73,873

 

 

74,590

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

28,500

 

 

27,900

 

 

8,325

 

 

5,853

 

 

4,503

 

Net securities gains/(losses)

 

 

3,928

 

 

5,561

 

 

 

 

188

 

 

(443

)

Other than temporary losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,684

)

 

 

 

 

Noninterest income, excluding net securities gains/(losses) and other than temporary losses

 

 

43,705

 

 

38,589

 

 

34,984

 

 

35,224

 

 

33,959

 

Noninterest expenses

 

 

91,556

 

 

88,545

 

 

84,476

 

 

79,478

 

 

77,238

 

Income before taxes

 

 

9,184

 

 

14,330

 

 

25,182

 

 

23,954

 

 

26,365

 

Provision for income taxes

 

 

2,158

 

 

4,908

 

 

9,176

 

 

8,560

 

 

5,367

 

Income from continuing operations

 

 

7,026

 

 

9,422

 

 

16,006

 

 

15,394

 

 

20,998

 

(Loss)/income from discontinued operations, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(795

)

 

(603

)

Loss on sale of discontinued operations, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(9,635

)

Net income

 

 

7,026

 

 

9,422

 

 

16,006

 

 

14,599

 

 

10,760

 

Dividends on preferred shares and accretion

 

 

2,589

 

 

2,773

 

 

102

 

 

 

 

 

Net income available to common shareholders

 

 

4,437

 

 

6,649

 

 

15,904

 

 

14,599

 

 

10,760

 

Income from continuing operations available to common shareholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Per average common share—basic

 

 

0.18

 

 

0.37

 

 

0.89

 

 

0.84

 

 

1.12

 

 

—diluted

 

 

0.18

 

 

0.37

 

 

0.88

 

 

0.82

 

 

1.09

 

Net income available to common shareholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Per average common share—basic

 

 

0.18

 

 

0.37

 

 

0.89

 

 

0.79

 

 

0.57

 

 

—diluted

 

 

0.18

 

 

0.37

 

 

0.88

 

 

0.78

 

 

0.56

 

Dividends per common share

 

 

0.36

 

 

0.56

 

 

0.76

 

 

0.76

 

 

0.76

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

YEAR END BALANCE SHEETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

 

789,315

 

 

737,065

 

 

793,924

 

 

618,490

 

 

565,214

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

 

33,889

 

 

23,403

 

 

23,756

 

 

33,320

 

Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

1,314,234

 

 

1,195,415

 

 

1,184,585

 

 

1,152,796

 

 

1,072,057

 

Other assets—discontinued operations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,663

 

Total assets, including discontinued operations

 

 

2,360,457

 

 

2,165,609

 

 

2,179,101

 

 

1,979,650

 

 

1,850,571

 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

 

570,290

 

 

546,337

 

 

464,585

 

 

501,023

 

 

505,898

 

Savings NOW and money market deposits

 

 

562,207

 

 

592,015

 

 

564,205

 

 

467,446

 

 

447,601

 

Time deposits

 

 

615,267

 

 

442,315

 

 

329,034

 

 

524,189

 

 

527,986

 

Short-term borrowings

 

 

60,894

 

 

131,854

 

 

363,404

 

 

205,418

 

 

83,776

 

Advances—FHLB and long-term debt

 

 

169,947

 

 

155,774

 

 

175,774

 

 

65,774

 

 

45,774

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

222,742

 

 

161,950

 

 

160,480

 

 

121,071

 

 

132,263

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

 

768,184

 

 

719,485

 

 

744,169

 

 

582,327

 

 

641,310

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

35,354

 

 

41,225

 

 

23,286

 

 

43,919

 

 

40,992

 

Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

1,227,049

 

 

1,154,041

 

 

1,120,362

 

 

1,049,206

 

 

984,307

 

Total assets, including discontinued operations

 

 

2,244,569

 

 

2,114,221

 

 

2,066,628

 

 

1,875,615

 

 

1,929,739

 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

 

489,184

 

 

441,087

 

 

427,105

 

 

424,425

 

 

420,683

 

Savings NOW and money market deposits

 

 

564,061

 

 

562,780

 

 

522,807

 

 

498,827

 

 

434,167

 

Time deposits

 

 

559,203

 

 

375,742

 

 

451,031

 

 

556,869

 

 

517,166

 

Short-term borrowings

 

 

112,207

 

 

271,075

 

 

279,840

 

 

131,573

 

 

255,204

 

Advances—FHLB and long-term debt

 

 

158,351

 

 

174,981

 

 

163,479

 

 

44,130

 

 

59,938

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

213,153

 

 

158,225

 

 

119,791

 

 

124,140

 

 

143,178

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RATIOS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Return on average total assets

 

 

0.31

%

 

0.45

%

 

0.77

%

 

0.82

%

 

1.14

%

Return on average shareholders’ equity

 

 

3.30

 

 

5.95

 

 

13.36

 

 

12.40

 

 

14.67

 

Dividend payout ratio

 

 

126.29

 

 

107.52

 

 

85.43

 

 

89.35

 

 

67.70

 

Average shareholders’ equity to average total assets

 

 

9.50

 

 

7.48

 

 

5.80

 

 

6.62

 

 

7.76

 

Net interest margin (tax-equivalent basis)

 

 

4.25

 

 

4.63

 

 

4.60

 

 

4.48

 

 

4.63

 

Loans/assets, year end[2]

 

 

57.03

 

 

56.77

 

 

55.44

 

 

59.43

 

 

59.79

 

Net charge-offs/loans, year end[3]

 

 

2.25

 

 

1.95

 

 

0.54

 

 

0.50

 

 

0.45

 

Nonperforming loans/loans, year end[2]

 

 

0.49

 

 

1.46

 

 

0.61

 

 

0.54

 

 

0.53

 

Allowance/loans, year end[3]

 

 

1.39

 

 

1.66

 

 

1.35

 

 

1.31

 

 

1.52

 


 

 

[1]

All data presented is from continuing operations unless indicated otherwise. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior years’ financial data to conform to current financial statement presentations.

 

 

[2]

In this calculation, the term “loans” means loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio.

 

 

[3]

In this calculation, the term “loans” means loans held in portfolio.

PAGE 31


Sterling Bancorp
MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following commentary presents management’s discussion and analysis of the financial condition and results of operations of Sterling Bancorp (the “parent company”), a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, and its subsidiaries, principally Sterling National Bank. Throughout this discussion and analysis, the term the “Company” refers to Sterling Bancorp and its subsidiaries and the term the “bank” refers to Sterling National Bank and its subsidiaries. This discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and selected financial data contained elsewhere in this annual report. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior years’ financial data to conform to current financial statement presentations. Throughout management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations, dollar amounts in tables are presented in thousands, except per share data.

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AND FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS

Certain statements contained or incorporated by reference in this annual report on Form 10-K, including but not limited to, statements concerning future results of operations or financial position, borrowing capacity and future liquidity, future investment results, future credit exposure, future loan losses and plans and objectives for future operations, economic environment and other statements contained herein regarding matters that are not historical facts, are “forward-looking statements” as defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These statements are not historical facts but instead are subject to numerous assumptions, risks and uncertainties, and represent only our belief regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. Any forward-looking statements the Company may make speak only as of the date on which such statements are made. Our actual results and financial position may differ materially from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in or implied by these forward-looking statements, and the Company makes no commitment to update or revise forward-looking statements in order to reflect new information or subsequent events or changes in expectations.

Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, the following: inflation, interest rates, market and monetary fluctuations; geopolitical developments including acts of war and terrorism and their impact on economic conditions; the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies and laws, including interest rate policies of the Federal Reserve Board; changes, particularly declines, in general economic conditions and in the local economies in which the Company operates; the financial condition of the Company’s borrowers; competitive pressures on loan and deposit pricing and demand; changes in technology and their impact on the marketing of new products and services and the acceptance of these products and services by new and existing customers; the willingness of customers to substitute competitors’ products and services for the Company’s products and services; the impact of changes in financial services laws and regulations (including laws concerning taxes, banking, securities and insurance); changes in accounting principles, policies and guidelines; the risks and uncertainties described in ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS on pages 17–27; other risks and uncertainties described from time to time in press releases and other public filings; and the Company’s performance in managing the risks involved in any of the foregoing. The foregoing list of important factors is not exclusive, and the Company will not update any forward-looking statement, whether written or oral, that may be made from time to time.

RECENT MARKET DEVELOPMENTS

In response to the financial crises affecting the banking system and financial markets and going concern threats to investment banks and other financial institutions, on October 3, 2008, the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (the “EESA”) was signed into law. Pursuant to EESA, the United States Department of the Treasury (the “U.S. Treasury”) was given the authority to, among other things, purchase up to $700 billion of mortgages, mortgage-backed securities and certain other financial instruments from financial institutions for the purpose of stabilizing and providing liquidity to the U.S. financial markets.

On October 14, 2008, the Secretary of the Department of the Treasury announced that the U.S. Treasury will purchase equity stakes in a wide variety of banks and thrifts. Under the program, known as the Troubled Asset Relief Program (“TARP”) Capital Purchase Program, from the $700 billion authorized by EESA, the U.S. Treasury made $250 billion of capital available to U.S. financial institutions in the form of preferred stock. In conjunction with the purchase of preferred stock, the U.S. Treasury received, from participating financial institutions, warrants to purchase common stock with an aggregate market price equal to 15% of the preferred investment. Participating financial institutions were required to adopt the U.S. Treasury’s standards for executive compensation and corporate governance for the period during which the U.S. Treasury holds equity issued under the TARP Capital Purchase Program. On December 23, 2008, the Company

PAGE 32


elected to participate in the TARP Capital Purchase Program, under which the Company issued preferred shares and a warrant to purchase common shares to the U.S. Treasury. As of the date of this report, the Company has not yet repurchased the preferred stock or the warrant to purchase common stock.

On November 21, 2008, the Board of Directors of the FDIC adopted a final rule relating to the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (“TLG Program”). The TLG Program was announced by the FDIC on October 14, 2008, preceded by the determination of systemic risk by the Secretary of the Department of Treasury (after consultation with the President), as an initiative to counter the system-wide crisis in the nation’s financial sector. Under the TLG Program (as amended from time to time thereafter) the FDIC would (i) guarantee, through the earlier of maturity or June 30, 2012, certain newly issued senior unsecured debt issued by participating institutions and (ii) provide full FDIC deposit insurance coverage for non-interest bearing transaction deposit accounts, Negotiable Order of Withdrawal (“NOW”) accounts paying less than 0.5% interest per annum and Interest on Lawyers Trust Accounts (“IOLA”) accounts held at participating FDIC-insured institutions. The transaction account guarantee program described in clause (ii) will expire on June 30, 2010. Coverage under the TLG Program was available for the first 30 days without charge. The fee assessment for coverage of senior unsecured debt ranges from 50 basis points to 100 basis points per annum, depending on the initial maturity of the debt. The fee assessment for deposit insurance coverage is 10 basis points per quarter on amounts in covered accounts exceeding $250,000. The Company elected to opt out of the debt guarantee program under the TLG Program, which may disadvantage the Company in its access to less expensive capital compared to the Company’s competitors that did not opt out.

On February 10, 2009, the Treasury Secretary announced a new comprehensive financial stability plan which included: (i) a capital assistance program that has invested in convertible preferred stock of certain qualifying institutions, (ii) a consumer and business lending initiative to fund new consumer loans, small business loans and commercial mortgage asset-backed securities issuances, (iii) a public-private investment fund intended to leverage public and private capital with public financing to purchase legacy “toxic assets” from financial institutions, and (iv) assistance for homeowners to reduce mortgage payments and interest rates and establishing loan modification guidelines for government and private programs.

In response to concerns relating to capital adequacy of large financial institutions, the Federal Reserve Board implemented Supervisory Capital Assessment Program (“SCAP”) under which all banking institutions with assets over $100 billion were required to undergo a comprehensive “stress test” to determine if they had sufficient capital to continue lending and to absorb losses that could result from a more severe decline in the economy than projected. The results of the stress test were announced on May 7, 2009. In addition, on September 3, 2009, the U.S. Treasury issued a policy statement relating to bank capital requirements, which calls for higher and stronger capital requirements for bank and non-bank financial firms that are deemed to pose a risk to financial stability due to their combination of size, leverage, interconnectedness and liquidity risk. Also, on December 17, 2009, the Basel Committee issued a set of proposals relating to the capital adequacy and liquidity risk exposures of financial institutions.

In order to restore the depleted Deposit Insurance Fund and maintain a sound reserve ratio, the FDIC imposed higher base assessment rates and special one-time assessments and required prepayment of deposit insurance premium. The FDIC stated that, after its semi-annual reviews, it may further increase assessment rates or take other actions to bring the Deposit Insurance Fund’s reserve ratio back to a desirable level.

In June of 2009, the Obama administration proposed a wide range of regulatory reforms that included, among other things, proposals (i) that any financial firm whose combination of size, leverage and interconnectedness could pose a threat to financial stability be subject to certain enhanced regulatory requirements, (ii) that federal bank regulators require loan originators or sponsors to retain part of the credit risk of securitized exposures, (iii) that there be increased regulation of broker-dealers and investment advisers, (iv) for the creation of a federal consumer financial protection agency that would, among other things, be charged with applying consistent regulations to similar products (such as imposing certain notice and consent requirements on consumer overdraft lines of credit), (v) that there be comprehensive regulation of OTC derivatives, (vi) that the controls on the ability of banking institutions to engage in transactions with affiliates be tightened, and (vii) that financial holding companies be required to be “well-capitalized” and “well-managed” on a consolidated basis.

PAGE 33


On October 22, 2009, the Federal Reserve Board issued a comprehensive proposal on incentive compensation policies intended to ensure that the incentive compensation policies of banking organizations do not undermine the safety and soundness of such organizations by encouraging excessive risk-taking. The proposal covers all employees that have the ability to materially affect the risk profile of an organization, either individually or as part of a group.

For more detailed discussion on recent legislative and regulatory developments, see “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” on pages 3–15.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND ESTIMATES

The accounting and reporting policies followed by the Company conform, in all material respects, to U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”). In preparing the consolidated financial statements, management has made estimates, assumptions and judgments based on information available as of the date of the financial statements; accordingly, as this information changes, the financial statements may reflect different estimates, assumptions and judgments. Certain policies inherently have greater reliance on the use of estimates, assumptions and judgments and, as such, have a greater possibility of producing results that could be materially different than originally reported. Estimates, assumptions and judgments are necessary when assets and liabilities are required to be recorded at fair value, when a decline in the value of an asset not carried on the financial statements at fair value warrants an impairment write-down or valuation allowance to be established, or when an asset or liability must be recorded contingent upon a future event. Carrying assets and liabilities at fair value inherently results in more financial statement volatility. The fair values and the information used to record valuation adjustments for certain assets and liabilities are based either on quoted market prices or are provided by other third-party sources, when readily available. Management evaluates its estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis using historical experience and other factors, including the current economic environment, which management believes to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Company adjusts such estimates and assumptions when the Company believes facts and circumstances dictate. Illiquid credit markets, volatile equity, foreign currency and energy markets and declines in consumer spending have combined to increase the uncertainty inherent in such estimates and assumptions. As future events and their effects cannot be determined with precision, actual results could differ significantly from these estimates. Changes in those estimates resulting from continuing changes in the economic environment will be reflected in the financial statements in the future periods.

The Company’s accounting policies are fundamental to understanding management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations. The most significant accounting policies followed by the Company are presented in Note 1 beginning on page 64. The accounting for factoring transactions also is discussed under “BUSINESS OPERATIONS —The Bank—Commercial Lending, Asset-Based Financing and Factoring/Accounts Receivable Management” on pages 1 and 2.

The Company has identified its policies on the valuation of securities, the allowance for loan losses and income tax liabilities to be critical because management has to make subjective and/or complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and could be subject to revision as new information becomes available. Additional information on these policies can be found in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.

Management utilizes various inputs to determine the fair value of its securities portfolio. Fair value of securities is based upon market prices, where available (Level 1 inputs). If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon market prices determined by an outside, independent entity that primarily uses, as inputs, observable market-based parameters (Level 2 inputs). Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments may include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality and the Company’s creditworthiness, among other things, as well as unobservable parameters (Level 3 inputs). Any such valuation adjustments are applied consistently over time. The Company’s valuation methodologies may produce a fair value calculation that may not be indicative of net realized value or reflective of future fair values. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date. Additional discussion of valuation methodologies is presented in Note 23 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

PAGE 34


A periodic review is conducted by management to determine if the decline in the fair value of any security appears to be other-than-temporary. Factors considered in determining whether the decline is other-than-temporary include, but are not limited to: the length of time and the extent to which fair value has been below cost; the financial condition and near- term prospects of the issuer; and the Company’s ability and intent to hold the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery of cost. If the decline is deemed to be other-than-temporary, and the Company has the ability and intent to hold the security until there is a recovery of cost, the security is written down to new cost basis and the resulting credit component of the loss is reported in noninterest income and the remainder of the loss is recorded in shareholders’ equity. If the Company does not have the ability and intent to hold the security until there is a recovery of cost, the full amount of the other-than-temporary impairment is recorded in noninterest income. Additional discussion of management’s evaluation process and other-than-temporary-impairment charges is presented in Note 1 and in Note 5.

The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio. Determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses is considered a critical accounting estimate because it requires significant judgment and the use of estimates related to the amount and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans based on historical loss experience, and consideration of current economic trends and conditions, all of which may be susceptible to significant change. The methodology used to determine the allowance for loan losses is outlined in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements and a discussion of the factors driving changes in the amount of the allowance for loan losses is included under the caption “Asset Quality” beginning on page 44.

The objectives of accounting for income taxes are to recognize the amount of taxes payable or refundable for the current year and deferred tax liabilities and assets for the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in an entity’s financial statements or tax returns. Judgment is required in assessing the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements or tax returns. Fluctuations in the actual outcome of these future tax consequences could impact the Company’s consolidated financial condition or results of operations. In connection with determining its income tax provision under Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“Codification”) Topic 740: Income Taxes, the Company maintains a reserve related to certain tax positions and strategies that management believes contain an element of uncertainty. The Company evaluates each of its tax positions and strategies periodically to determine whether the reserve continues to be appropriate. Additional discussion on the accounting for income taxes is presented in Note 1 and in Note 21 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

OVERVIEW

The Company provides a broad range of financial products and services, including business and consumer loans, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, asset-based financing, factoring/accounts receivable management services, trade financing, equipment financing, and deposit services. The Company has operations in the New York metropolitan area and conducts business throughout the United States. The general state of the U.S. economy and, in particular, economic and market conditions in the New York metropolitan area have a significant impact on loan demand, the ability of borrowers to repay these loans and the value of any collateral securing these loans and may also affect deposit levels. Accordingly, future general economic conditions are a key uncertainty that management expects will materially affect the Company’s results of operations.

On April 3, 2009, Sterling Factors Corporation, a subsidiary of the bank, acquired substantially all of the assets and customer lists of DCD Capital, LLC and DCD Trade Services, LLC. The acquired assets and customer lists are now operating as a division under the name Sterling Trade Capital.

In 2010, the bank’s average earning assets represented approximately 98.3% of the Company’s average earning assets. Loans represented 61.2% and investment securities represented 36.8% of the bank’s average earning assets in 2010.

The Company’s primary source of earnings is net interest income, and its principal market risk exposure is interest rate risk. The Company is not able to predict market interest rate fluctuations and its asset/liability management strategy may not prevent interest rate changes from having a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.

PAGE 35


Although management endeavors to minimize the credit risk inherent in the Company’s loan portfolio, it must necessarily make various assumptions and judgments about the collectibility of the loan portfolio based on its experience and evaluation of economic conditions. If such assumptions or judgments prove to be incorrect, the current allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover loan losses and additions to the allowance may be necessary, which would have a negative impact on net income.

There is intense competition in all areas in which the Company conducts its business. The Company competes with banks and other financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks, finance companies, and credit unions. Many of these competitors have substantially greater resources and lending limits and provide a wider array of banking services. To a limited extent, the Company also competes with other providers of financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage firms, consumer finance companies and insurance companies. Competition is based on a number of factors, including prices, interest rates, services, availability of products and geographic location.

The Company regularly evaluates acquisition opportunities and conducts due diligence activities in connection with possible acquisitions. As a result, acquisition discussions, and in some cases negotiations, regularly take place and future acquisitions could occur.

Taxable-equivalent adjustments are the result of increasing income from tax-free loans and investments by an amount equal to the taxes that would be paid if the income were fully taxable-based on a 35% federal tax rate, thus making tax-exempt yields comparable to taxable asset yields.

INCOME STATEMENT ANALYSIS

Net interest income, which represents the difference between interest earned on interest-earning assets and interest incurred on interest-bearing liabilities, is the Company’s primary source of earnings. Net interest income can be affected by changes in market interest rates as well as the level and composition of assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity. Net interest spread is the difference between the average rate earned, on a tax-equivalent basis, on interest-earning assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. The net yield on interest-earning assets (“net interest margin”) is calculated by dividing tax equivalent net interest income by average interest-earning assets. Generally, the net interest margin will exceed the net interest spread because a portion of interest-earning assets are funded by various noninterest-bearing sources, principally noninterest-bearing deposits and shareholders’ equity. The increases (decreases) in the components of interest income and interest expense, expressed in terms of fluctuation in average volume and rate, are provided in the RATE/VOLUME ANALYSIS shown on page 51. Information as to the components of interest income and interest expense and average rates is provided in the AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS shown on page 50.

COMPARISON OF THE YEARS 2010 AND 2009

The Company reported net income available to common shareholders for 2010 of $4.4 million, representing $0.18 per share calculated on a diluted basis, compared to $6.6 million, or $0.37 per share calculated on a diluted basis, for 2009. The $2.2 million decrease in net income available to common shareholders was primarily due to a $8.7 million decrease in interest income, a $3.0 million increase in noninterest expenses and a $0.6 million increase in the provision for loan losses, which more than offset a $3.5 million increase in non-interest income, a $3.7 million decrease in interest expense, a $2.8 lower provision for income taxes and a reduction of $0.2 million decrease in dividends and accretion related to the preferred shares issued to the U.S. Treasury under the TARP Capital Purchase Program.

Net Interest Income

Net interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, was $84.2 million for 2010 compared to $87.6 million for 2009. Net interest income benefitted from higher average loan and investment securities balances, lower borrowings and lower cost of funding. Partially offsetting those benefits was the impact of lower yields on loans and investment securities, coupled with higher interest-bearing deposit balances. The net interest margin, on a tax-equivalent basis, was 4.25% for 2010 compared to 4.63% for 2009. The net interest margin was impacted by the lower interest rate environment in 2010, the higher level of noninterest-bearing demand deposits and the effect of higher average loans and investment securities outstanding.

Total interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, aggregated $99.8 million for 2010, down $7.2 million from 2009. The tax-equivalent yield on interest-earning assets was 5.04% for 2010 compared to 5.65% for 2009.

Interest earned on the loan portfolio decreased to $70.1 million for 2010 from $71.8 million for the prior year period.

PAGE 36



Average loan balances amounted to $1,262.4 million, an increase of $67.1 million from an average of $1,195.3 million in the prior year period. The increase in average loans, primarily due to the Company’s business development activities, accounted for a $3.7 million increase in interest earned on loans. The yield on the loan portfolio decreased to 5.98% for 2010 from 6.38% for 2009 period, which was primarily attributed to the mix of average outstanding balances among the components of the loan portfolio.

Interest earned on the securities portfolio, on a tax-equivalent basis, decreased to $29.2 million for 2010 from $34.6 million in 2009. Average outstandings increased to $768.2 million (37.1% of average earning assets) for 2010 from $719.5 million (36.7% of average earning assets) in 2009. The average yield on investment securities decreased to 3.80% for 2010 from 4.80% in 2009. The decrease in both balances and yield reflect the impact of the Company’s asset/ liability management strategy designed to shorten the average life of the portfolio to position the Company for rising interest rates in future periods while taking advantage of the current uptick in long term rates. The short-term part of the strategy was implemented through the sale of available for sale securities, principally mortgage-backed securities, with longer term average lives offset by the purchase of short-term corporate debt and obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises. The long-term part of the strategy was implemented through the purchase of obligations of state and political subdivisions with maturities of approximately 10 years.

Total interest expense decreased by $3.7 million for 2010 from $19.3 million for 2009 period, primarily due to the impact of lower rates paid, coupled with lower balances for borrowings, partially offset by the impact of higher interest-bearing deposit balances.

Interest expense on deposits decreased to $9.6 million for 2010 from $11.9 million for the 2009 period, primarily due to a decrease in the cost of those funds. The average rate paid on interest-bearing deposits was 0.85%, which was 42 basis points lower than the prior year period. The decrease in average cost of interest-bearing deposits reflects the impact of deposit pricing strategies and the Company’s purchase of certificates of deposit from CDARS which provided deposit balances at lower rates than paid for traditional certificate of deposit products. Average interest-bearing deposits were $1,123.3 million for 2010 compared to $938.5 million for 2009, reflecting an increase in certificates of deposit, largely to the CDARS program which is a lower cost product than traditional certificates of deposit.

Interest expense on borrowings decreased to $6.0 million for 2010 from $7.4 million for 2009 primarily due to lower balances partially offset by the impact of changes in mix. Average borrowings decreased to $270.6 million for 2010 from $446.1 million in the prior year period, reflecting a lesser reliance by the Company on wholesale borrowed funds. The change in mix resulted in an increase in the blended cost of borrowing to 2.22% from 1.66%.

Provision for Loan Losses

In light of recent economic developments and continued economic uncertainty, during the third quarter the Company decided, after consultation with external professionals and regulators, to implement an accelerated resolution of certain categories of nonaccrual loans. As a result, net charge-offs during 2010 of loans to small business borrowers (primarily in the lease financing portfolio) increased $6.3 million when compared to the comparable 2009 period. Based on management’s continuing evaluation of the loan portfolio (discussed under “Asset Quality” on page 44), the provision for loan losses for 2010 was $28.5 million, compared to $27.9 million for the prior year period.

The level of the allowance reflects changes in the size of the portfolio or in any of its components as well as management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio quality, present economic, and political and regulatory conditions. Portions of the allowance may be allocated for specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.

During 2010, the allowance for loan losses decreased primarily due to a reduction in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables, partially offset by increases in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans, factored receivables, real estate residential mortgage, and real estate commercial mortgage and real estate construction and land development. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables decreased primarily as a result of the lower level of lease financing receivables nonaccrual balances. The increase of the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans was primarily the result of the unsteady economic recovery resulting in higher charge-offs in 2010 compared to

PAGE 37


2009 partially offset by lower nonaccrual levels at December 31, 2010 compared to December 31, 2009. The allowance allocated to factored receivables increased based on the continued weakening in the consumer sectors resulting in higher charge-off in 2010 compared to 2009. The increase in the allowance allocated to real estate residential mortgage loans was primarily due to the persistent decline in residential real estate values coupled with an increase in the specific valuation allowance for impaired residential mortgage loans. As a result of the disruption in the commercial real estate markets, resulting in an increase in nonaccrual levels and higher specific reserves for classified loans At December 31, 2010 when compared to December 31, 2009, the allowance allocated to real estate commercial mortgage and to real estate construction and land development was increased.

Noninterest Income

Noninterest income increased to $47.6 million for 2010 from $44.2 million in 2009. The increase principally resulted from higher income related to accounts receivable management and factoring services offset partly by lower mortgage banking income and securities gains. Commissions and other fees earned from accounts receivable management and factoring services were higher primarily due to the impact of increased volumes at our factoring unit and billings by clients providing temporary staffing also contributed to the improved level of fee income. Mortgage banking declined due to a lower volume of loans closed and a change in the mix of products being sold. Securities gains declined and reflected a modification of the asset liability management program commenced in 2009 that was designed to reduce the average life of the investment securities portfolio which was replaced by the strategy that was described under Net Interest Income on page 36. The Company sold approximately $165.8 million of securities with a weighted average life of approximately 2.4 years. The Company expects to reinvest a significant portion of the proceeds in securities with an average life of less than two years.

Noninterest Expenses

Noninterest expenses were $91.6 million for 2010, compared to $88.5 million in 2009, primarily reflecting higher compensation and occupancy expenses related to the growth of the business and increased business development activities.

Provision for Income Taxes

The provision for income taxes for 2010 decreased to $2.2 million from $4.9 million for 2009. The decrease was primarily due to lower taxable income and a lower effective income tax rate in the 2010 period (23.5%) compared to the 2009 period (34.2%). The decrease in the effective tax rate was primarily related to the higher proportion of tax-exempt income achieved in 2010 compared to 2009 coupled with a lower level of pre-tax income.

COMPARISON OF THE YEARS 2009 AND 2008

The Company reported net income available to common shareholders for 2009 of $6.6 million, representing $0.37 per share calculated on a diluted basis, compared to $15.9 million, or $0.88 per share calculated on a diluted basis, for 2008. The $9.3 million decrease in net income available to common shareholders was primarily due to a $19.6 million increase in the provision for loan losses, a $4.1 million increase in noninterest expenses and a $2.7 million increase in dividends and accretion related to the preferred shares issued to the U.S. Treasury under the TARP Capital Purchase Program, which more than offset a $10.9 million increase in noninterest income, a $1.9 million increase in net interest income and a $4.3 million lower provision for income taxes.

Net Interest Income

Net interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, was $87.6 million for 2009 compared to $85.1 million for 2008. Net interest income benefitted from higher average loan balances, lower interest-bearing deposit balances and lower cost of funding. Partially offsetting those benefits was the impact of lower yield on loans and investment securities, lower investment securities balances and higher borrowed funds balances. The net interest margin, on a tax-equivalent basis, was 4.63% for 2009 compared to 4.60% for 2008. The net interest margin was impacted by the lower interest rate environment in 2009, the higher level of noninterest-bearing demand deposits and the effect of higher average loans outstanding.

Total interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, aggregated $106.9 million for 2009, down $11.6 million from 2008. The tax-equivalent yield on interest-earning assets was 5.65% for 2009 compared to 6.40% for 2008.

PAGE 38


Interest earned on the loan portfolio decreased to $71.8 million for 2009 from $80.4 million for the prior year period. Average loan balances amounted to $1,195.3 million, an increase of $51.7 million from an average of $1,143.6 million in the prior year period. The increase in average loans, primarily due to the Company’s business development activities, accounted for a $3.3 million increase in interest earned on loans. The yield on the loan portfolio decreased to 6.38% for 2009 from 7.37% for 2008 period, which was primarily attributable to the lower interest rate environment in 2009 and the mix of average outstanding balances among the components of the loan portfolio.

Interest earned on the securities portfolio, on a tax-equivalent basis, decreased to $34.6 million for 2009 from $37.4 million in 2008. Average outstandings decreased to $719.5 million (36.7% of average earning assets) for 2009 from $744.2 million (39.0% of average earning assets) in 2008. The average yield on investment securities decreased to 4.80% for 2009 from 5.03% in 2008. The decrease in both balances and yield reflect the impact of the Company’s asset/liability management strategy designed to shorten the average life of the portfolio coupled with calls of higher yielding securities. Under this strategy, the Company sold principally available for sale mortgage-backed securities with longer term average lives and replaced them with short-term corporate debt and U.S. Government Agency securities.

Offsetting the impact of the above, the average life was lengthened as a result of the impact of purchases of longer term municipal securities and the impact on our portfolio of callable U.S. Government Agency securities. Due to upward movement of interest rates at December 31, 2009, the prices on our portfolio of U.S. Government Agency securities declined below par value, making it less likely that these issues would be called. As a result, the average life of the securities portfolio was lengthened to approximately 5.4 years at December 31, 2009 compared to approximately 4.8 years at December 31, 2008.

Total interest expense decreased by $14.1 million for 2009 from $33.4 million for 2008 period, primarily due to the impact of lower rates paid, coupled with lower balances for interest-bearing deposits and borrowings.

Interest expense on deposits decreased to $11.9 million for 2009 from $21.5 million for the 2008 period, primarily due to a decrease in the cost of those funds. The average rate paid on interest-bearing deposits was 1.27%, which was 94 basis points lower than the prior year period. The decrease in average cost of deposits reflects the lower interest rate environment during 2009. Average interest-bearing deposits were $938.5 million for 2009 compared to $973.8 million for 2008, reflecting the Company’s strategy to reduce reliance on higher-priced certificates of deposit.

Interest expense on borrowings decreased to $7.4 million for 2009 from $11.9 million for 2008 period, primarily due to lower rates paid for borrowed funds coupled with the benefit (reflected in the volume change) derived from the elimination of funding through dealer repurchase agreements partially offset by increased short-term borrowings from the Federal Reserve Bank. The average rate paid for borrowed funds was 1.66%, which was 102 basis points lower than the prior year period. The decrease in the average cost of borrowings reflects the lower interest rate environment in 2009. Average borrowings increased to $446.1 million for 2009 from $443.3 million in the prior year period, reflecting greater reliance by the Company on wholesale funding.

Provision for Loan Losses

Based on management’s continuing evaluation of the loan portfolio (discussed under “Asset Quality” beginning on page 44), the provision for loan losses for 2009 was $27.9 million, compared to $8.3 million for 2008. Factors affecting the larger provision for 2009 included further deterioration of economic conditions during that period, a $16.9 million increase in net charge-offs, a $10.6 million increase in nonaccrual loans and growth in the loan portfolio.

The level of the allowance reflects changes in the size of the portfolio or in any of its components as well as management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio quality, present economic, and political and regulatory conditions. Portions of the allowance may be allocated for specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.

During 2009, the allowance for loan losses increased because of increases in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables and in the allowance allocated to commercial and

PAGE 39


industrial loans partially offset by a reduction in the allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables increased primarily as a result of increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The impact of the increase in nonaccrual lease financing receivables at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 was mitigated by decreasing levels of nonaccruals in that category in the third and fourth quarters of 2009 compared to the second quarter of 2009. The allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans increased due to increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 and higher nonaccrual levels in that category at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans decreased primarily due to lower nonaccrual loan balances at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 coupled with a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. During the fourth quarter of 2009 the level of the allowance for loan losses benefitted from a recovery of $0.9 million on a loan charged off in a prior period.

Noninterest Income

Noninterest income increased to $44.2 million for 2009 from $33.3 million in the 2008 period. The increase principally resulted from securities gains recognized in the 2009 period compared to securities losses recognized in the 2008 period. Also contributing to the increase were higher income related to accounts receivable management and factoring services, higher mortgage banking income, and higher service charges on deposit accounts. In connection with an asset/liability management program designed to reduce the average life of the investment securities portfolio, the Company sold approximately $227.6 million of securities with a weighted average life of approximately 3.3 years. The Company reinvested a significant portion of the proceeds in securities with an average life of less than two years. The 2008 amount was reduced by other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) charges which resulted from management’s regular review of the investment portfolio. One charge, taken in the second quarter of 2008 for a single-issuer, investment grade trust preferred security, amounted to approximately $0.5 million and reduced the carrying amount of the security to $0.5 million. A second charge, taken in the third quarter of 2008 for a debt security, amounted to approximately $1.2 million and reduced the carrying amount of the security to $2.6 million. Commissions and other fees earned from accounts receivable management and factoring services were higher primarily due to the impact of the acquisition of the business of DCD Capital, LLC and DCD Trade Services, LLC on April 6, 2009. Partially offsetting that benefit was the impact of reduced volume of billing by clients providing temporary staffing. The increase in mortgage banking income was due to higher volume of loans sold.

Noninterest Expenses

Noninterest expenses for 2009 increased $4.0 million when compared to 2008. The increase was primarily due to the impact of the acquisition of the business of DCD Capital, LLC and DCD Trade Services, LLC on April 6, 2009 and higher deposit insurance and pension costs. Partially offsetting these increases was a reduction in expenses for professional services.

The increase in deposit insurance cost was due to a special assessment levied in the 2009 second quarter by the FDIC on all insured depository institutions totaling 5 basis points of each institution’s total assets less Tier 1 capital as of June 30, 2009, not to exceed 10 basis points of domestic deposits. The special assessment is part of the FDIC’s effort to rebuild the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”). In conjunction with the amended plan, the FDIC implemented a final rule on November 17, 2009 requiring insured institutions to prepay their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011 and 2012. The bank’s prepaid amount to the FDIC was $8.3 million.

The increase in pension expense was primarily the result of weaker return on plan assets during 2008. The Company’s defined benefit retirement plan was closed to new members effective as of January 3, 2007. There have been no new participants in the Company’s Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (“SERP”). The defined benefit plan was replaced by an enhanced 401(k) contribution for new employees. The Company still has funding obligations related to the defined benefit retirement plan and SERP and will recognize retirement expense related to these plans in future years, which will be dependent on the return earned on plan assets, the level of interest rates, salary increases, employee turnover and other factors.

Provision for Income Taxes

The provision for income taxes for 2009 decreased to $4.9 million, reflecting an effective tax rate of 34.2%, compared with $9.2 million for 2008, reflecting an effective tax rate of 36.4%. The decrease was primarily due to an increase in the proportion of tax-exempt income in the 2009 period.

PAGE 40


BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS

Securities

At December 31, 2010, the Company’s portfolio of securities totaled $789.3 million, of which obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises amounted to $434.4 million which is approximately 55.0% of the total. The Company has the intent and ability to hold to maturity securities classified as held to maturity, at which time it will receive full value for these securities. These securities are carried at cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts. The gross unrealized gains and losses on held to maturity securities were $7.9 million and $6.7 million, respectively. Securities classified as available for sale may be sold in the future, prior to maturity. These securities are carried at fair value. Net aggregate unrealized gains or losses on these securities are included, net of taxes, as a component of shareholders’ equity. Given the generally high credit quality of the portfolio, management expects to realize all of its investment upon market recovery or, the maturity of such instruments and thus believes that any impairment in value is interest rate related and therefore temporary. Available for sale securities included gross unrealized gains of $1.6 million and gross unrealized losses of $1.7 million. As of December 31, 2010, management does not have the intent to sell any of the securities classified as available for sale in the table on page 42 and management believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell any such securities before a recovery of cost. During 2008, the Company recognized OTTI charges totaling $1.7 million which are included in noninterest income under the caption “Other-than-temporary losses.” These securities were subsequently sold at a minimal gain.

The following table sets forth the composition of the Company’s investment securities by type, with related carrying values at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

 

 







Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

7,504

 

 

0.95

%

$

13,740

 

 

1.86

%

$

20,799

 

 

2.62

%

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

 

47,422

 

 

6.01

 

 

22,698

 

 

3.08

 

 

42,294

 

 

5.33

 

CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)

 

 

7,290

 

 

0.92

 

 

9,048

 

 

1.23

 

 

6,565

 

 

0.83

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

78,822

 

 

9.98

 

 

125,673

 

 

17.05

 

 

245,100

 

 

30.87

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

40,628

 

 

5.15

 

 

71,715

 

 

9.73

 

 

137,437

 

 

17.31

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

5,052

 

 

0.64

 

 

13,146

 

 

1.78

 

 

39,564

 

 

4.98

 

 

 



















Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

186,718

 

 

23.65

 

 

256,020

 

 

34.73

 

 

491,759

 

 

61.94

 

Agency Notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

115,133

 

 

14.59

 

 

116,603

 

 

15.82

 

 

 

 

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

24,932

 

 

3.16

 

 

102,799

 

 

13.95

 

 

174,675

 

 

22.00

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

92,479

 

 

11.72

 

 

29,418

 

 

3.99

 

 

89,844

 

 

11.32

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

15,109

 

 

1.91

 

 

14,899

 

 

2.02

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



















Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

434,371

 

 

55.03

 

 

519,739

 

 

70.51

 

 

756,278

 

 

95.26

 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

 

 

157,013

 

 

19.89

 

 

83,337

 

 

11.31

 

 

23,406

 

 

2.95

 

Single issuer, trust preferred securities

 

 

3,933

 

 

0.50

 

 

4,483

 

 

0.61

 

 

4,209

 

 

0.53

 

Corporate securities

 

 

189,058

 

 

23.95

 

 

129,200

 

 

17.53

 

 

9,724

 

 

1.22

 

Other securities

 

 

4,940

 

 

0.63

 

 

56

 

 

0.01

 

 

57

 

 

0.01

 

 

 



















Total marketable securities

 

 

789,315

 

 

100.00

 

 

736,815

 

 

99.97

 

 

793,674

 

 

99.97

 

Debt securities issued by foreign governments

 

 

 

 

 

 

250

 

 

0.03

 

 

250

 

 

0.03

 

 

 



















Total

 

$

789,315

 

 

100.00

%

$

737,065

 

 

100.00

%

$

793,924

 

 

100.00

%

 

 



















The following table presents information regarding the average life and yields of certain available for sale (“AFS”) and held to maturity (“HTM”) securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted Average Life

 

Weighted Average Yield

 

 

 


 


 

December 31, 2010

 

AFS

 

HTM

 

AFS

 

HTM

 











Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

3.2 years

 

 

2.6 years

 

 

2.50

%

 

4.66

%

Agency notes (with original call dates ranging between 3 and 36 months)

 

 

1.7 years

 

 

7.1 years

 

 

1.96

 

 

1.51

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

0.7 years

 

 

 

 

2.19

 

 

 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

 

 

9.5 years

 

 

14.3 years

 

 

5.55

[1]

 

5.86

[1]

[1] Tax equivalent

PAGE 41


The following tables present information regarding securities available for sale and securities held to maturity at December 31, 2010, based on contractual maturity. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. The average yield on obligation of state and political subdivisions securities is presented on a tax-equivalent basis.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available for sale

 

Amortized
Cost

 

Fair
Value

 

Weighted
Average
Yield

 








Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

$

36,026

 

$

35,718

 

 

2.57

%

CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)

 

 

7,218

 

 

7,290

 

 

1.09

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

8,750

 

 

8,821

 

 

3.35

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

44

 

 

45

 

 

6.30

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

110

 

 

109

 

 

1.27

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

52,148

 

 

51,983

 

 

2.50

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

19,988

 

 

20,056

 

 

1.49

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

10,099

 

 

10,108

 

 

2.00

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

10,000

 

 

9,941

 

 

2.06

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

19,983

 

 

20,071

 

 

2.13

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

29,981

 

 

29,915

 

 

2.22

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,031

 

 

1.14

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

152,199

 

 

152,105

 

 

2.11

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due within 1 year

 

 

1,419

 

 

1,440

 

 

5.15

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

10,918

 

 

11,457

 

 

5.13

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

4,927

 

 

5,130

 

 

5.67

 

Due after 10 years

 

 

22,703

 

 

22,017

 

 

5.75

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

39,967

 

 

40,044

 

 

5.55

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Single-issuer trust preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 10 years

 

 

3,879

 

 

3,933

 

 

7.46

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due within 6 months

 

 

102,831

 

 

102,960

 

 

2.11

 

Due after 6 months but within 1 year

 

 

61,603

 

 

61,607

 

 

2.32

 

Due after 1 year but within 2 years

 

 

12,690

 

 

12,612

 

 

2.29

 

Due after 2 years but within 5 years

 

 

11,967

 

 

11,879

 

 

2.14

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total corporate debt securities

 

 

189,091

 

 

189,058

 

 

2.19

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Other securities

 

 

5,039

 

 

4,940

 

 

3.06

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total available for sale

 

$

390,175

 

$

390,080

 

 

2.57

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

PAGE 42



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Held to maturity

 

Carrying
Value

 

Fair
Value

 

Weighted
Average
Yield

 








Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

7,504

 

$

7,853

 

 

5.37

%

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

 

11,704

 

 

12,276

 

 

4.55

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

70,001

 

 

74,293

 

 

4.46

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

40,583

 

 

42,514

 

 

4.69

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

4,943

 

 

5,548

 

 

6.45

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

134,735

 

 

142,484

 

 

4.66

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

24,993

 

 

24,694

 

 

1.42

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

29,979

 

 

29,156

 

 

1.60

 

Due after 10 years

 

 

29,997

 

 

29,719

 

 

2.17

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

14,991

 

 

14,769

 

 

1.13

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 1 year but within 5 years

 

 

24,995

 

 

24,807

 

 

1.03

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

17,498

 

 

17,082

 

 

1.01

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due after 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

5,078

 

 

5,036

 

 

3.34

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

282,266

 

 

287,747

 

 

3.02

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due within 5 years but within 10 years

 

 

1,077

 

 

1,097

 

 

5.04

 

Due after 10 years

 

 

115,892

 

 

111,609

 

 

5.87

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

116,969

 

 

112,706

 

 

5.86

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total held to maturity

 

$

399,235

 

$

400,453

 

 

3.85

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Loan Portfolio

A management objective is to maintain the quality of the loan portfolio. The Company seeks to achieve this objective by maintaining rigorous underwriting standards coupled with regular evaluation of the creditworthiness of and the designation of lending limits for each borrower. The portfolio strategies include seeking industry and loan size diversification in order to minimize credit exposure and originating loans in markets with which the Company is familiar.

The Company’s commercial and industrial loan and factored receivables portfolios represents approximately 58% of all loans. Loans in this category are typically made to individuals, small and medium-sized businesses in amounts generally up to $20 million. The Company’s equipment financing portfolio, which consists of finance leases for various types of business equipment, represents approximately 11% of all loans. The leasing and commercial and industrial loan portfolios are included in corporate lending for segment reporting purposes as presented in Note 25 beginning on page 108. The Company’s real estate loan portfolios, which represent approximately 21% of all loans, are secured by mortgages on real property located principally in the states of New York, New Jersey, Connecticut, Virginia and North Carolina. Sources of repayment are from the borrower’s operating profits, cash flows and liquidation of pledged collateral. Based on underwriting standards, loans and leases may be secured whole or in part by collateral such as liquid assets, accounts receivable, equipment, inventory, and real property. The collateral securing any loan or lease may depend on the type of loan and may vary in value based on market conditions.

PAGE 43


The following table, restated to reflect the disposition of Sterling Financial (see “BUSINESS” beginning on page 1), sets forth the composition of the Company’s loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

 













 

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

 

 





















Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

618,223

 

45.92

%

$

550,285

 

44.76

%

$

531,471

 

44.00

%

$

518,265

 

44.05

%

$

501,882

 

45.40

%

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

144,235

 

10.72

 

 

195,056

 

15.87

 

 

255,743

 

21.17

 

 

249,702

 

21.22

 

 

207,771

 

18.80

 

Factored receivables

 

 

161,789

 

12.02

 

 

139,927

 

11.38

 

 

89,145

 

7.38

 

 

80,007

 

6.80

 

 

79,721

 

7.21

 

Real estate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage—portfolio

 

 

127,695

 

9.49

 

 

124,681

 

10.14

 

 

142,135

 

11.76

 

 

129,465

 

11.00

 

 

120,056

 

10.86

 

Residential mortgage—held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

2.38

 

 

33,889

 

2.76

 

 

23,403

 

1.94

 

 

23,756

 

2.02

 

 

33,320

 

3.02

 

Commercial mortgage

 

 

96,991

 

7.20

 

 

92,614

 

7.53

 

 

96,883

 

8.02

 

 

99,093

 

8.42

 

 

93,215

 

8.43

 

Construction and land development

 

 

25,624

 

1.90

 

 

24,277

 

1.97

 

 

25,249

 

2.09

 

 

37,161

 

3.16

 

 

30,031

 

2.72

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

11,370

 

0.84

 

 

12,984

 

1.06

 

 

18,959

 

1.57

 

 

12,103

 

1.03

 

 

12,381

 

1.12

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

15,425

 

1.15

 

 

20,000

 

1.63

 

 

25,000

 

2.07

 

 

27,000

 

2.30

 

 

27,000

 

2.44

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

112,882

 

8.38

 

 

35,591

 

2.90

 

 

N/A

 

 

 

N/A

 

 

 

N/A

 

 

 

 


























Total

 

$

1,346,283

 

100.00

%

$

1,229,304

 

100.00

%

$

1,207,988

 

100.00

%

$

1,176,552

 

100.00

%

$

1,105,377

 

100.00

%

 

 


























The following table sets forth the maturities of the Company’s commercial and industrial, factored receivables and construction and land development loans, as of December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due One
Year
or Less

 

Due One
to Five
Years

 

Due
After Five
Years

 

Total
Gross
Loans

 










Commercial and industrial

 

$

512,432

 

$

70,398

 

$

37,306

 

$

620,136

 

Factored receivables

 

 

162,070

 

 

 

 

 

 

162,070

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

12,889

 

 

9,150

 

 

3,585

 

 

25,624

 

All commercial and industrial loans due after one year have predetermined interest rates.

All real estate—construction and land development loans due after one year have floating or adjustable interest rates.

Asset Quality

Intrinsic to the lending process is the possibility of loss. In times of economic slowdown, the risk of loss inherent in the Company’s portfolio of loans may increase. While management endeavors to minimize this risk, it recognizes that loan losses will occur and that the amount of these losses will fluctuate depending on the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio which in turn depend on current and future economic conditions, the financial condition of borrowers, the realization of collateral, and the credit management process.

Nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2010 decreased $11.3 million compared to December 31, 2009. This primarily reflected decreases of $3.2 million and $11.1 million in commercial and industrial loans and lease financing receivables, respectively, partially offset by an increase of $3.1 million in commercial real estate mortgage loans. Net loan charge-offs in 2010 were $6.3 million higher than those in 2009 (primarily reflecting increases in net charge-offs of $2.8 million for lease financing receivables and $3.0 million for commercial and industrial loans). A worsening of existing economic conditions will likely result in levels of charge-offs and nonaccrual loans that will be higher than those in the historical levels.

PAGE 44


The following table, restated to reflect the disposition of Sterling Financial (see “BUSINESS” beginning on page 1), sets forth the amount of domestic nonaccrual and past due loans of the Company at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years; there were no foreign loans accounted for on a nonaccrual basis. At December 31, 2010, approximately $6.1 million of equipment financing receivables and residential real estate loans were troubled debt restructurings. See Note 6 beginning on page 77 for additional discussion. Loans contractually past due 90 days or more as to principal or interest and still accruing are loans that are both well-secured or guaranteed by financially responsible third parties and are in the process of collection.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

 













Gross loans

 

$

1,365,296

 

$

1,254,946

 

$

1,245,263

 

$

1,249,128

 

$

1,177,705

 

 

 
















Nonaccrual loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

1,014

 

$

4,231

 

$

816

 

$

610

 

$

1,490

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

892

 

 

11,960

 

 

3,387

 

 

2,571

 

 

2,933

 

Factored receivables

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

1,614

 

 

1,786

 

 

3,078

 

 

2,786

 

 

1,011

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

3,124

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

 

 

 

 

63

 

 

416

 

 

427

 

 

 
















Total nonaccrual loans

 

 

6,644

 

 

17,977

 

 

7,344

 

 

6,383

 

 

5,861

 

Past due 90 days or more (other than the above)

 

 

4,085

 

 

1,194

 

 

821

 

 

1,329

 

 

989

 

 

 
















Total

 

$

10,729

 

$

19,171

 

$

8,165

 

$

7,712

 

$

6,850

 

 

 
















Interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans outstanding

 

$

902

 

$

1,463

 

$

731

 

$

655

 

$

545

 

 

 
















Applicable interest income actually realized on nonaccrual loans outstanding

 

$

204

 

$

743

 

$

321

 

$

222

 

$

335

 

 

 
















Nonaccrual and past due loans as a percentage of total gross loans

 

 

0.79

%

 

1.53

%

 

0.66

%

 

0.62

%

 

0.58

%

 

 
















At December 31, 2010, commercial and industrial nonaccruals represented 0.16% of commercial and industrial loans. There were 6 loans made to small business borrowers located in 3 states with balances ranging between approximately $33.2 thousand and $497.6 thousand.

At December 31, 2010, equipment financing nonaccruals represented 0.62% of lease financing receivables. The lessees of the equipment are located in 11 states. There were 16 leases ranging between approximately $345 and $268.9 thousand. The value of the underlying collateral related to lease financing nonaccruals varies depending on the type and condition of equipment. While most leases are written on a recourse basis, with personal guarantees of the principals, the current value of the collateral is often less than the lease financing balance. Collection efforts include repossession and/or sale of leased equipment, payment discussions with the lessee, the principal and/or guarantors, and obtaining judgments against the lessee, the principal and/or guarantors. The balance is charged off at the earlier of when the lease is past due 120 days or when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive. Factors considered in determining whether collection efforts are no longer productive include any amounts currently being collected, the status of discussions or negotiations with the lessee, the principal and/or guarantors, the cost of continuing efforts to collect, the status of any foreclosure or other legal actions, the value of the collateral, and any other pertinent factors.

At December 31, 2010, residential real estate nonaccruals represented 1.26% of residential real estate loans held in portfolio. There were 12 loans ranging between approximately $10.2 thousand and $413.2 thousand secured by properties located in 6 states.

At December 31, 2010, commercial real estate nonaccruals represented 3.22% of commercial real estate loans. There was one loan for $745.3 thousand and another for $2.4 million secured by property located in 1 state.

At December 31, 2010, other real estate owned consisted of one property valued at $31.7 thousand and another valued at $150.0 thousand located in 2 states.

PAGE 45


The allowance for loan losses is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that have incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The Company’s allowance for loan losses methodology includes allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310, Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450, Contingencies. Accordingly, the methodology is based on historical loss experience by type of credit and internal risk grade, specific homogenous pools and specific loss allocations, with adjustments for current events and conditions. The Company’s process for the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses is designed to account for credit deterioration as it occurs. The provision for loan losses reflects loan quality trends, including the levels of and trends related to non-accrual loans, past due loans, potential problem loans, classified and criticized loans and net charge-offs or recoveries, among other factors. The provision for loan losses also reflects the totality of actions taken on all loans for a particular period. In other words, the amount of the provision reflects not only the necessary increases in the allowance for loan losses related to newly identified criticized loans, but it also reflects actions taken related to other loans including, among other things, any necessary increases or decreases in required allowances for specific loans or loan pools. See Note 6—Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses in the accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report for further details regarding the methodology for estimating the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses.

At December 31, 2010, the ratio of the allowance to loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, was 1.39% and the allowance was $18.2 million. Loans 90 days past due and still accruing amounted to $314 thousand. At such date, the Company’s nonaccrual loans amounted to $6.6 million; $4.5 million of such loans were judged to be impaired within the scope of FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, and had a valuation allowance totaling $1.4 million, which is included within the overall allowance for loan losses. Based on the foregoing, as well as management’s judgment as to the current risks inherent in loans held in portfolio, the Company’s allowance for loan losses was deemed adequate to absorb all probable losses on specifically known and other credit risks associated with the portfolio as of December 31, 2010. Net losses within loans held in portfolio are not statistically predictable and changes in conditions in the next twelve months could result in future provisions for loan losses varying from the provision taken in 2010. Potential problem loans, which are loans that are currently performing under present loan repayment terms but where known information about possible credit problems of borrowers causes management to have serious doubts as to the ability of the borrowers to continue to comply with the present repayment terms, aggregated $-0- and $2.4 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

PAGE 46


The following table, restated to reflect the disposition of Sterling Financial (see “BUSINESS” beginning on page 1), sets forth certain information with respect to the Company’s loan loss experience for each of the five most recent fiscal years:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

 













Average loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, during year

 

$

1,227,049

 

$

1,154,041

 

$

1,120,362

 

$

1,049,206

 

$

984,307

 

 

 
















Allowance for loan losses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

19,872

 

$

16,010

 

$

15,085

 

$

16,288

 

$

15,369

 

 

 
















Charge-offs:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

 

7,212

 

 

4,945

 

 

2,610

 

 

2,620

 

 

1,075

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

22,509

 

 

19,115

 

 

3,886

 

 

3,345

 

 

4,618

 

Factored receivables

 

 

665

 

 

514

 

 

581

 

 

243

 

 

223

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

351

 

 

312

 

 

58

 

 

215

 

 

24

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

129

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

231

 

 

 

 

 

 

67

 

 

 

 

 
















Total charge-offs

 

 

31,097

 

 

24,886

 

 

7,135

 

 

6,490

 

 

5,940

 

 

 
















Recoveries:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

 

312

 

 

1,042

 

 

297

 

 

219

 

 

786

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

902

 

 

345

 

 

294

 

 

316

 

 

310

 

Factored receivables

 

 

239

 

 

63

 

 

26

 

 

31

 

 

32

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

 

 

102

 

 

61

 

 

30

 

 

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

48

 

 

 

 

69

 

 

110

 

 

38

 

 

 
















Total recoveries

 

 

1,501

 

 

1,552

 

 

747

 

 

706

 

 

1,166

 

 

 
















Subtract:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

 

 

29,596

 

 

23,334

 

 

6,388

 

 

5,784

 

 

4,774

 

 

 
















Provision for loan losses

 

 

28,500

 

 

27,900

 

 

8,325

 

 

5,853

 

 

4,503

 

 

 
















Add allowance from acquisition

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,845

 

 

 
















Less loss on transfers to other real estate owned

 

 

538

 

 

704

 

 

1,012

 

 

1,272

 

 

655

 

 

 
















Balance at end of year

 

$

18,238

 

$

19,872

 

$

16,010

 

$

15,085

 

$

16,288

 

 

 
















Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, during year

 

 

2.41

%

 

2.02

%

 

0.57

%

 

0.55

%

 

0.49

%

 

 
















PAGE 47


The following table, restated to reflect the disposition of Sterling Financial (see “BUSINESS” beginning on page 1), presents the Company’s allocation of the allowance for loan losses. This allocation is based on estimates by management and may vary from year to year based on management’s evaluation of the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio. The amount allocated to a particular loan category of the Company’s loans held in portfolio may not necessarily be indicative of actual future charge-offs in that loan category.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

 













 

 

Amount

 

% of
Loans
in each
category
to total
loans
held in
portfolio

 

Amount

 

% of
Loans
in each
category
to total
loans
held in
portfolio

 

Amount

 

% of
Loans
in each
category
to total
loans
held in
portfolio

 

Amount

 

% of
Loans
in each
category
to total
loans
held in
portfolio

 

Amount

 

% of
Loans
in each
category
to total
loans
held in
portfolio

 

 

 





















Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

7,454

 

 

47.04

%

$

6,082

 

 

46.03

%

$

5,530

 

 

44.87

%

$

5,655

 

 

44.96

%

$

6,488

 

 

46.82

%

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

46

 

 

1.17

 

 

 

 

1.67

 

 

88

 

 

2.11

 

 

54

 

 

2.34

 

 

135

 

 

2.52

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

564

 

 

8.59

 

 

 

 

2.98

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

3,423

 

 

10.97

 

 

10,249

 

 

16.32

 

 

6,130

 

 

21.59

 

 

5,398

 

 

21.66

 

 

6,356

 

 

19.38

 

Factored receivables

 

 

1,424

 

 

12.31

 

 

971

 

 

11.70

 

 

933

 

 

7.52

 

 

1,083

 

 

6.94

 

 

1,127

 

 

7.44

 

Real estate—residential mortgage (portfolio)

 

 

2,497

 

 

9.72

 

 

1,646

 

 

10.43

 

 

2,355

 

 

12.00

 

 

1,988

 

 

11.23

 

 

1,468

 

 

11.20

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

2,275

 

 

7.38

 

 

560

 

 

7.75

 

 

674

 

 

8.18

 

 

613

 

 

8.60

 

 

501

 

 

8.69

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

310

 

 

1.95

 

 

149

 

 

2.03

 

 

175

 

 

2.13

 

 

183

 

 

3.22

 

 

150

 

 

2.80

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

119

 

 

0.87

 

 

80

 

 

1.09

 

 

88

 

 

1.60

 

 

15

 

 

1.05

 

 

 

 

1.15

 

Unallocated

 

 

126

 

 

 

 

135

 

 

 

 

37

 

 

 

 

96

 

 

 

 

63

 

 

 

 

 































Total

 

$

18,238

 

 

100.00

%

$

19,872

 

 

100.00

%

$

16,010

 

 

100.00

%

$

15,085

 

 

100.00

%

$

16,288

 

 

100.00

%

 

 































During 2010, the allowance for loan losses decreased $1.6 million from $19.9 million at December 31, 2009 primarily due to a reduction in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables ($6.8 million) partially offset by increases in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans ($1.4 million), factored receivables ($0.5 million), real estate residential mortgage ($0.9 million), and real estate commercial mortgage ($1.7 million) and real estate construction and land development ($0.2 million). The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables decreased primarily as a result of the lower level of lease financing receivables nonaccrual balances. The increase of the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans was primarily the result of the unsteady economic recovery. The allowance to factored receivables increased based on the continued weakening in the consumer sectors. The increase in the allowance allocated to real estate residential mortgage was primarily due to the persistent decline in residential real estate values. As a result of the disruption in the commercial real estate markets, the allowance allocated to real estate commercial mortgage and to real estate construction and land development was increased.

During 2009, the allowance for loan losses increased because of increases in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables and in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans, partially offset by a reduction in the allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables increased primarily as a result of increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The impact of the increase in nonaccrual lease financing receivables at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 was mitigated by decreasing levels of nonaccruals in that category in the third and fourth quarters of 2009 compared to the second quarter of 2009. The allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans increased due to increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 and higher nonaccrual levels in that category at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans decreased primarily due to lower nonaccrual loan balances at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 coupled with a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. During the fourth quarter of 2009 the level of the allowance for loan losses benefitted from a recovery of $0.9 million on a loan charged off in a prior period.

During 2008, the allowance for loan losses increased primarily because of increases in the allowance allocated to lease financing and in the allowance allocated to real estate—residential mortgage loans. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables increased primarily as a result of increased losses experienced in that category in 2008 compared to 2007 and an increase in the specific valuation

PAGE 48


allowance for impaired loans. The allowance allocated to real estate—residential mortgage loans increased primarily due to increased risks in the real estate market in 2008 compared to 2007 and an increase in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans.

During 2007, the allowance for loan losses decreased primarily because of decreases in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans and lease financing receivables more than offset an increase in the allowance allocated to real estate—residential mortgage loans. During 2007 the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans decreased primarily as a result of another year of low loss experience in Sterling Resource Funding Corp. compared to its loss experience before the Company acquired it as of April 1, 2006. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables decreased primarily as a result of improved loss experience in that category in 2007 compared to 2006. The allowance allocated to real estate—residential mortgage loans increased primarily due to increased risks in the real estate market in 2007 compared to 2006 and an increase in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans.

Deposits

A significant source of funds are customer deposits, consisting of demand (noninterest-bearing), NOW, savings, money market and time deposits (principally certificates of deposit).

The following table provides certain information with respect to the Company’s deposits at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

Balances

 

% of
Total

 

 

 



Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Demand

 

$

570,290

 

 

32.63

%

$

546,332

 

 

34.56

%

$

464,572

 

 

34.22

%

NOW

 

 

200,521

 

 

11.47

 

 

266,343

 

 

16.85

 

 

224,754

 

 

16.55

 

Savings

 

 

18,931

 

 

1.08

 

 

17,497

 

 

1.11

 

 

18,083

 

 

1.33

 

Money Market

 

 

342,755

 

 

19.61

 

 

308,175

 

 

19.50

 

 

321,368

 

 

23.67

 

Time deposits less than $100 thousand

 

 

126,834

 

 

7.26

 

 

140,678

 

 

8.90

 

 

116,601

 

 

8.59

 

Time deposits greater than $100 thousand

 

 

488,433

 

 

27.95

 

 

301,057

 

 

19.04

 

 

211,855

 

 

15.60

 

 

 



















Total domestic deposits

 

 

1,747,764

 

 

100.00

 

 

1,580,082

 

 

99.96

 

 

1,357,233

 

 

99.96

 

Foreign

 



















Demand

 

 

 

 

 

 

5

 

 

 

 

13

 

 

 

Time deposits greater than $100 thousand

 

 

 

 

 

 

580

 

 

0.04

 

 

578

 

 

0.04

 

 

 



















Total foreign deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

585

 

 

0.04

 

 

591

 

 

0.04

 

 

 



















Total deposits

 

$

1,747,764

 

 

100.0

%

$

1,580,667

 

 

100.00

%

$

1,357,824

 

 

100.00

%

 

 



















The Company began participating in the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”) on January 22, 2009. CDARS deposits totaled approximately $180.7 million at December 31, 2010 and averaged approximately $184.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. CDARS deposits totaled approximately $82.3 million at December 31, 2009 and averaged approximately $42.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.

Scheduled maturities of time deposits at December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

2011

 

$

563,264

 

2012 and later

 

 

52,003

 

 

 



 

 

 

$

615,267

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

Scheduled maturities of time deposits in amounts of $100,000 or more at December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due within 3 months or less

 

$

147,259

 

Due after 3 months and within 6 months

 

 

197,301

 

Due after 6 months and within 12 months

 

 

117,742

 

Due after 12 months

 

 

26,131

 

 

 



 

 

 

$

488,433

 

 

 



 

Fluctuations of balances in total or among categories at any date can occur based on the Company’s mix of assets and liabilities, as well as on customers’ balance sheet strategies. Historically, however, average balances for deposits have been relatively stable. Information regarding these average balances for the three most recent fiscal years is presented on page 50.

PAGE 49


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS AND
ANALYSIS OF NET INTEREST EARNINGS[ 1 ]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

Average
Balance

 

Interest

 

Average
Rate

 

Average
Balance

 

Interest

 

Average
Rate

 

Average
Balance

 

Interest

 

Average
Rate

 

 

 




























ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

$

31,960

 

$

75

 

 

0.23

%

$

36,804

 

$

85

 

 

0.23

%

$

5,727

 

$

42

 

 

0.74

%

Investment securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available for sale—taxable

 

 

394,635

 

 

10,863

 

 

2.75

 

 

350,069

 

 

16,575

 

 

4.73

 

 

390,337

 

 

20,453

 

 

5.24

 

Held to maturity—taxable

 

 

252,915

 

 

10,879

 

 

4.30

 

 

320,655

 

 

15,070

 

 

4.70

 

 

332,033

 

 

15,718

 

 

4.73

 

Tax-exempt[2]

 

 

120,634

 

 

7,422

 

 

6.15

 

 

48,761

 

 

2,907

 

 

5.96

 

 

21,799

 

 

1,268

 

 

5.82

 

Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

 

8,617

 

 

448

 

 

5.20

 

 

9,487

 

 

516

 

 

5.45

 

 

11,908

 

 

598

 

 

5.02

 

Federal funds sold

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

444

 

 

8

 

 

1.84

 

Loans, net of unearned discounts[3]

 

 

1,262,403

 

 

70,104

 

 

5.98

 

 

1,195,266

 

 

71,788

 

 

6.38

 

 

1,143,648

 

 

80,445

 

 

7.37

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

TOTAL INTEREST-EARNING ASSETS

 

 

2,071,164

 

 

99,791

 

 

5.04

%

 

1,961,042

 

 

106,941

 

 

5.65

%

 

1,905,896

 

 

118,532

 

 

6.40

%

 

 

 

 

 



 



 

 

 

 



 



 

 

 

 



 



 

Cash and due from banks

 

 

36,810

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

31,118

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

49,269

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

 

(21,668

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(19,107

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(16,087

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

22,901

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22,901

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22,901

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other

 

 

135,362

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

118,267

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

104,649

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL ASSETS

 

$

2,244,569

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,114,221

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,066,628

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Savings

 

$

18,631

 

 

11

 

 

0.06

%

$

18,012

 

 

18

 

 

0.10

%

$

18,460

 

 

59

 

 

0.32

%

NOW

 

 

209,197

 

 

472

 

 

0.23

 

 

211,121

 

 

620

 

 

0.29

 

 

239,944

 

 

2,306

 

 

0.96

 

Money market

 

 

336,233

 

 

2,805

 

 

0.83

 

 

333,647

 

 

3,252

 

 

0.97

 

 

264,403

 

 

4,038

 

 

1.53

 

Time

 

 

558,886

 

 

6,297

 

 

1.13

 

 

375,164

 

 

7,993

 

 

2.13

 

 

450,455

 

 

15,099

 

 

3.35

 

Foreign

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Time

 

 

317

 

 

3

 

 

1.09

 

 

578

 

 

6

 

 

1.09

 

 

576

 

 

6

 

 

1.09

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing deposits

 

 

1,123,264

 

 

9,588

 

 

0.85

 

 

938,522

 

 

11,889

 

 

1.27

 

 

973,838

 

 

21,508

 

 

2.21

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Borrowings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

47,674

 

 

229

 

 

0.48

 

 

72,892

 

 

353

 

 

0.48

 

 

89,602

 

 

1,855

 

 

2.07

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

5,618

 

 

44

 

 

0.79

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

41,808

 

 

1,127

 

 

2.69

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

33,192

 

 

74

 

 

0.22

 

 

25,075

 

 

51

 

 

0.21

 

 

50,368

 

 

899

 

 

1.79

 

Commercial paper

 

 

14,718

 

 

45

 

 

0.30

 

 

13,107

 

 

67

 

 

0.51

 

 

17,806

 

 

461

 

 

2.59

 

Short-term borrowings—FHLB

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,411

 

 

11

 

 

0.31

 

 

69,708

 

 

1,309

 

 

1.88

 

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

3,699

 

 

9

 

 

0.25

 

 

154,726

 

 

398

 

 

0.26

 

 

8,841

 

 

47

 

 

0.53

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

7,306

 

 

18

 

 

0.25

 

 

1,864

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,707

 

 

35

 

 

2.04

 

Advances—FHLB

 

 

132,577

 

 

3,482

 

 

2.63

 

 

149,207

 

 

4,432

 

 

2.97

 

 

137,705

 

 

4,053

 

 

2.94

 

Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures

 

 

25,774

 

 

2,094

 

 

8.38

 

 

25,774

 

 

2,094

 

 

8.38

 

 

25,774

 

 

2,094

 

 

8.38

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total borrowings

 

 

270,558

 

 

5,995

 

 

2.22

 

 

446,056

 

 

7,406

 

 

1.66

 

 

443,319

 

 

11,880

 

 

2.68

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

 

 

1,393,822

 

 

15,583

 

 

1.12

%

 

1,384,578

 

 

19,295

 

 

1.39

%

 

1,417,157

 

 

33,388

 

 

2.36

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

 

489,184

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

441,087

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

427,105

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

Total including noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

 

1,883,006

 

 

15,583

 

 

0.83

%

 

1,825,665

 

 

19,295

 

 

1.06

%

 

1,844,262

 

 

33,388

 

 

1.81

%

 

 

 

 

 



 



 

 

 

 



 



 

 

 

 



 



 

Other liabilities

 

 

148,410

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

130,331

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

102,575

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

 

 

2,031,416

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,955,996

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,946,837

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

213,153

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

158,225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

119,791

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

$

2,244,569

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,114,221

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,066,628

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income/spread

 

 

 

 

 

84,208

 

 

3.92

%

 

 

 

 

87,646

 

 

4.26

%

 

 

 

 

85,144

 

 

4.04

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

Net yield on interest-earning assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.25

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.63

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.60

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

Less: Tax-equivalent adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

2,601

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

461

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

 

 

 

$

81,607

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

86,625

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

84,683

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 


 

 

[1]

The average balances of assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity are computed on the basis of daily averages. Average rates are presented on a tax-equivalent basis. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior period amounts to conform to current presentation.

 

 

[2]

Interest on tax-exempt securities included herein is presented on a tax-equivalent basis.

 

 

[3]

Includes loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio; all loans are domestic. Nonaccrual loans are included in amounts outstanding and income has been included to the extent earned.

PAGE 50


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED RATE/VOLUME ANALYSIS[ 1 ]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease) from Years Ended,

 

December 31, 2009 to
December 31, 2010

 

December 31, 2008 to
December 31, 2009

 





















 

 

Volume

 

Rate

 

Total[2]

 

Volume

 

Rate

 

Total[2]

 

 

 



 

 

(in thousands)

 

INTEREST INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

$

(10

)

$

 

$

(10

)

$

90

 

$

(47

)

$

43

 

 

 



















Investment securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available for sale—taxable

 

 

1,901

 

 

(7,613

)

 

(5,712

)

 

(2,021

)

 

(1,857

)

 

(3,878

)

Held to maturity—taxable

 

 

(2,987

)

 

(1,204

)

 

(4,191

)

 

(553

)

 

(95

)

 

(648

)

Tax-exempt

 

 

4,419

 

 

96

 

 

4,515

 

 

1,607

 

 

32

 

 

1,639

 

 

 



















Total

 

 

3,333

 

 

(8,721

)

 

(5,388

)

 

(967

)

 

(1,920

)

 

(2,887

)

 

 



















Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

 

(45

)

 

(23

)

 

(68

)

 

(130

)

 

48

 

 

(82

)

 

 



















Federal funds sold

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(8

)

 

 

 

(8

)

Loans, net of unearned discounts[3]

 

 

3,723

 

 

(5,407

)

 

(1,684

)

 

3,343

 

 

(12,000

)

 

(8,657

)

 

 



















TOTAL INTEREST INCOME

 

$

7,001

 

$

(14,151

)

$

(7,150

)

$

2,328

 

$

(13,919

)

$

(11,591

)

 

 



















INTEREST EXPENSE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Savings

 

$

1

 

$

(8

)

$

(7

)

$

(1

)

$

(40

)

$

(41

)

NOW

 

 

(7

)

 

(141

)

 

(148

)

 

(252

)

 

(1,434

)

 

(1,686

)

Money market

 

 

25

 

 

(472

)

 

(447

)

 

900

 

 

(1,686

)

 

(786

)

Time

 

 

2,965

 

 

(4,661

)

 

(1,696

)

 

(2,260

)

 

(4,846

)

 

(7,106

)

Foreign

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Time

 

 

(3

)

 

 

 

(3

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



















Total interest-bearing deposits

 

 

2,981

 

 

(5,282

)

 

(2,301

)

 

(1,613

)

 

(8,006

)

 

(9,619

)

 

 



















Borrowings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

(124

)

 

 

 

(124

)

 

(297

)

 

(1,205

)

 

(1,502

)

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

44

 

 

 

 

44

 

 

(1,127

)

 

 

 

(1,127

)

Federal funds purchased

 

 

20

 

 

3

 

 

23

 

 

(308

)

 

(540

)

 

(848

)

Commercial paper

 

 

8

 

 

(30

)

 

(22

)

 

(98

)

 

(296

)

 

(394

)

Short-term borrowings—FHLB

 

 

(11

)

 

 

 

(11

)

 

(692

)

 

(606

)

 

(1,298

)

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

(375

)

 

(14

)

 

(389

)

 

387

 

 

(36

)

 

351

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

 

 

18

 

 

18

 

 

 

 

(35

)

 

(35

)

Advances—FHLB

 

 

(469

)

 

(481

)

 

(950

)

 

337

 

 

42

 

 

379

 

 

 



















Total borrowings

 

 

(907

)

 

(504

)

 

(1,411

)

 

(1,798

)

 

(2,676

)

 

(4,474

)

 

 



















TOTAL INTEREST EXPENSE

 

$

2,074

 

$

(5,786

)

$

(3,712

)

$

(3,411

)

$

(10,682

)

$

(14,093

)

 

 



















NET INTEREST INCOME

 

$

4,927

 

$

(8,365

)

$

(3,438

)

$

5,739

 

$

(3,237

)

$

2,502

 

 

 




















 

 

[1]

Amounts are presented on a tax-equivalent basis.

 

 

[2]

The change in interest income and interest expense due to a combination of both volume and rate have been allocated to the change due to volume and the change due to rate in proportion to the relationship of the change due solely to each. The change in interest income for Federal funds sold and in interest expense for securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers and short-term borrowings—FRB has been allocated entirely to the volume variance. The effect of the extra day in 2008 has also been allocated entirely to the volume variance.

 

 

[3]

Includes loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio; all loans are domestic. Nonaccrual loans have been included in the amounts outstanding and income has been included to the extent earned.

PAGE 51


ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT

The Company’s primary earnings source is its net interest income; therefore, the Company devotes significant time and has invested in resources to assist in the management of interest rate risk and asset quality. The Company’s net interest income is affected by changes in market interest rates, and by the level and composition of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. The Company’s objectives in its asset/liability management are to utilize its capital effectively, to provide adequate liquidity and to enhance net interest income, without taking undue risks or subjecting the Company unduly to interest rate fluctuations.

The Company takes a coordinated approach to the management of its liquidity, capital and interest rate risk. This risk management process is governed by policies and limits established by senior management which are reviewed and approved by the Asset/Liability Committee. This committee, which is comprised of members of senior management, meets to review, among other things, economic conditions, interest rates, yield curve, cash flow projections, expected customer actions, liquidity levels, capital ratios and repricing characteristics of assets, liabilities and financial instruments.

Market Risk

Market risk is the risk of loss in a financial instrument arising from adverse changes in market indices such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates and equity prices. The Company’s principal market risk exposure is interest rate risk, with no material impact on earnings from changes in foreign exchange rates or equity prices.

Interest rate risk is the exposure to changes in market interest rates. Interest rate sensitivity is the relationship between market interest rates and net interest income due to the repricing characteristics of assets and liabilities. The Company monitors the interest rate sensitivity of its balance sheet positions by examining its near-term sensitivity and its longer-term gap position. In its management of interest rate risk, the Company utilizes several financial and statistical tools including traditional gap analysis and sophisticated income simulation models.

A traditional gap analysis is prepared based on the maturity and repricing characteristics of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities for selected time bands. The mismatch between repricings or maturities within a time band is commonly referred to as the “gap” for that period. A positive gap (asset sensitive) where interest rate sensitive assets exceed interest rate sensitive liabilities generally will result in the net interest margin increasing in a rising rate environment and decreasing in a falling rate environment. A negative gap (liability sensitive) will generally have the opposite result on the net interest margin. However, the traditional gap analysis does not assess the relative sensitivity of assets and liabilities to changes in interest rates and other factors that could have an impact on interest rate sensitivity or net interest income. The Company utilizes the gap analysis to complement its income simulations modeling, primarily focusing on the longer-term structure of the balance sheet.

The Company’s balance sheet structure is primarily short-term in nature with a substantial portion of assets and liabilities repricing or maturing within one year. The Company’s gap analysis at December 31, 2010, presented on page 56, indicates that net interest income would increase during periods of rising interest rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates, but, as mentioned above, gap analysis may not be an accurate predictor of net interest income.

As part of its interest rate risk strategy, the Company may use financial instrument derivatives to hedge the interest rate sensitivity of assets. The Company has written policy guidelines, approved by the Board of Directors, governing the use of financial instruments, including approved counterparties, risk limits and appropriate internal control procedures. The credit risk of derivatives arises principally from the potential for a counterparty to fail to meet its obligation to settle a contract on a timely basis.

As of December 31, 2010, the Company was not a party to any financial instrument derivative agreement. On September 14, 2008, an interest rate floor agreement with a notional amount of $50 million expired. At December 31, 2008, there were no amounts receivable under this contract.

The interest rate floor agreement was not designated as a hedge for accounting purposes and therefore changes in the fair value of the instrument were required to be recognized as current income or expense in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, $-0-, $-0- and $88 thousand were credited to noninterest income, respectively.

The Company utilizes income simulation models to complement its traditional gap analysis. While the Asset/Liability Committee routinely monitors simulated net interest income sensitivity over a rolling two-year horizon, it also utilizes additional tools to monitor potential longer-term interest rate risk. The income simulation models measure the Company’s net interest income volatility or sensitivity to interest rate changes utilizing statistical techniques that allow the Company to consider various factors which impact net interest income. These factors include actual maturities, estimated cash flows, repricing characteristics, deposits growth/retention and, most importantly, the relative sensitivity of the Company’s assets

PAGE 52


and liabilities to changes in market interest rates. This relative sensitivity is important to consider as the Company’s core deposit base has not been subject to the same degree of interest rate sensitivity as its assets. The core deposit costs are internally managed and tend to exhibit less sensitivity to changes in interest rates than the Company’s adjustable rate assets whose yields are based on external indices and generally change in concert with market interest rates.

The Company’s interest rate sensitivity is determined by identifying the probable impact of changes in market interest rates on the yields on the Company’s assets and the rates that would be paid on its liabilities. This modeling technique involves a degree of estimation based on certain assumptions that management believes to be reasonable. Utilizing this process, management projects the impact of changes in interest rates on net interest margin. The Company has established certain policy limits for the potential volatility of its net interest margin assuming certain levels of changes in market interest rates with the objective of maintaining a stable net interest margin under various probable rate scenarios. Management generally has maintained a risk position well within the policy limits. As of December 31, 2010, the model indicated the impact of a 100 and 200 basis point parallel and pro rata rise in rates over 12 months would approximate a 3.4% ($3.7 million) and a 6.8% ($7.2 million) increase in net interest income, respectively, while the impact of a 25 basis point decline in rates over the same period would approximate a 0.9% ($1.0 million) decline from an unchanged rate environment. The likelihood of a decrease in interest rates beyond 25 basis points as of December 31, 2010 was considered to be remote given then-current interest rate levels. As of December 31, 2009, the model indicated the impact of a 100 and 200 basis point parallel and pro rata rise in rates over 12 months would approximate a 2.6% ($2.7 million) and a 4.9% ($5.1 million) increase in net interest income, respectively, while the impact of a 25 basis point decline in rates over the same period would approximate a 1.3% ($1.3 million) decline from an unchanged rate environment. The likelihood of a decrease in interest rates beyond 25 basis points as of December 31, 2009 was considered to be remote given then-current interest rate levels.

The preceding sensitivity analysis does not represent a Company forecast and should not be relied upon as being indicative of expected operating results. These hypothetical estimates are based upon numerous assumptions including: the nature and timing of interest rate levels including yield curve shape, prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment/ replacement of asset and liability cash flows, and others. While assumptions are developed based upon current economic and local market conditions, the Company cannot provide any assurances as to the predictive nature of these assumptions, including how customer preferences or competitor influences might change.

Also, as market conditions vary from those assumed in the sensitivity analysis, actual results will also differ due to: prepayment/refinancing levels likely deviating from those assumed, the varying impact of interest rate change caps or floors on adjustable rate assets, the potential effect of changing debt service levels on customers with adjustable rate loans, depositor early withdrawals and product preference changes, and other variables. Furthermore, the sensitivity analysis does not reflect actions that the Asset/Liability Committee might take in responding to or anticipating changes in interest rates.

The shape of the yield curve can cause downward pressure on net interest income. In general, if and to the extent that the yield curve is flatter (i.e., the differences between interest rates for different maturities are relatively smaller) than previously anticipated, then the yield on the Company’s interest-earning assets and its cash flows will tend to be lower. Management believes that a relatively flat yield curve could continue to affect adversely the Company’s results in 2011.

Liquidity Risk

Liquidity is the ability to meet cash needs arising from changes in various categories of assets and liabilities. Liquidity is constantly monitored and managed at both the parent company and the bank levels. Liquid assets consist of cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits in banks and Federal funds sold and securities available for sale. Primary funding sources include core deposits, capital markets funds and other money market sources. Core deposits include domestic noninterest-bearing and interest-bearing retail deposits, which historically have been relatively stable. The parent company and the bank believe that they have significant unused borrowing capacity. Contingency plans exist which we believe could be implemented on a timely basis to mitigate the impact of any dramatic change in market conditions.

The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank. Such sources have been adequate to meet the parent company’s cash requirements throughout its history.

Various legal restrictions limit the extent to which the bank can supply funds to the parent company and its non-bank subsidiaries. All national banks are limited in the payment of dividends without the approval of the Comptroller of the Currency to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for the year to date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years.

PAGE 53


In December 2008, under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, we issued to the U.S. Treasury 42,000 of the parent company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Shares, Series A, liquidation preference of $1,000 per share (“Series A Preferred Shares”). Cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares are payable at 5% per annum for the first five years and at a rate of 9% per annum thereafter. In conjunction with its purchase of the Series A Preferred Shares, the U.S. Treasury also received a 10-year warrant to purchase up to 516,817 of the parent company’s common shares, at an exercise price of $12.19 per share, for an aggregate purchase price of $6.3 million in cash if the warrant is exercised in full. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series A Preferred Shares on the date of issuance (based on their relative fair values) were $2.6 million and $39.4 million, respectively. The Series A Preferred Shares will be accreted to the redemption price of $42 million over five years. The warrant is exercisable at any time until December 23, 2018, and the number of common shares underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events. If, on or before December 31, 2010, we had received aggregate gross cash proceeds of at least $42 million from sales of Tier 1 qualifying perpetual preferred shares or common shares, the number of common shares issuable upon exercise of the warrant would have been reduced by one-half of the original number of common shares so issuable.

At December 31, 2010, the parent company’s short-term debt, consisting principally of commercial paper used to finance ongoing current business activities, was approximately $15.4 million. The parent company had cash, interest-bearing deposits with banks and other current assets aggregating $66.5 million. The parent company also has back-up credit lines with banks of $19.0 million. Since 1979, the parent company has had no need to use available back-up lines of credit.

The following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s contractual cash obligations as of December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Payments Due by Period

 

 

 


 

Contractual
Obligations

 

Total

 

Less than
1 Year

 

1–2
Years

 

2–3
Years

 

3–4
Years

 

4–5
Years

 

After 5
Years

 

















Long-Term Debt[1]

 

$

169,947

 

$

30,000

 

$

10,000

 

$

82,024

 

$

2,149

 

$

 

$

45,774

 

Operating Leases

 

 

49,726

 

 

4,843

 

 

4,481

 

 

4,479

 

 

4,747

 

 

4,550

 

 

26,626

 

 

 






















Total Contractual Cash Obligations

 

$

219,673

 

$

34,843

 

$

14,481

 

$

86,503

 

$

6,896

 

$

4,550

 

$

72,400

 

 

 






















[1] Based on contractual maturity date.

The following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s obligations under other commercial commitments as of December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount of Commitment Expiration Per Period

 

 

 


 

Other Commercial
Commitments

 

Total

 

Less than
1 Year

 

1–2
Years

 

2–3
Years

 

3–4
Years

 

4–5
Years

 

After 5
Years

 

















Residential Loans

 

$

59,108

 

$

59,108

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

Commercial Loans

 

 

27,007

 

 

17,785

 

 

7,288

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,934

 

 

 






















Total Loan Commitments

 

 

86,115

 

 

76,893

 

 

7,288

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,934

 

Standby Letters of Credit

 

 

26,034

 

 

19,446

 

 

6,588

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other Commercial Commitments

 

 

68,775

 

 

68,590

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

185

 

 

 






















Total Commercial Commitments

 

$

180,924

 

$

164,929

 

$

13,876

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

2,119

 

 

 






















The Company is obligated under certain unfunded benefit plans to make payments to individuals upon their retirement. While the Company is not aware of any near term plans for retirement of executive officers at this time, actuarial expected benefit payments are disclosed in Note 20 beginning on page 95 based on eligibility.

While past performance is not a guarantee of future performance, management believes that the parent company’s funding sources (including dividends from all its subsidiaries) and the bank’s funding sources will be adequate to meet their liquidity requirements in the future.  

PAGE 54


CAPITAL

The Company and the bank are subject to risk-based capital regulations which quantitatively measure capital against risk-weighted assets, including certain off-balance sheet items. These regulations define the elements of the Tier 1 and Tier 2 components of total capital and establish minimum ratios of 4% for Tier 1 capital and 8% for Total Capital for capital adequacy purposes. Supplementing these regulations is a leverage requirement. This requirement establishes a minimum leverage ratio (at least 3% or 4%, depending upon an institution’s regulatory status), which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by adjusted quarterly average assets (after deducting goodwill). Information regarding the Company’s and the bank’s risk-based capital at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 is presented in Note 24 beginning on page 107. In addition, the bank is subject to the provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”) which imposes a number of mandatory supervisory measures. Among other matters, FDICIA established five capital categories ranging from “well capitalized” to “critically undercapitalized.” Such classifications are used by regulatory agencies to determine a bank’s deposit insurance premium, approval of applications authorizing institutions to increase their asset size or otherwise expand business activities or acquire other institutions. Under FDICIA, a “well capitalized” bank must maintain minimum leverage, Tier 1 and total capital ratios of 5%, 6% and 10%, respectively. The Federal Reserve Board applies comparable tests for holding companies such as the Company. At December 31, 2010, the Company and the bank exceeded the requirements for “well capitalized” institutions under the tests pursuant to FDICIA and of the Federal Reserve Board.

The bank regulatory agencies have encouraged banking organizations, including healthy, well run banking organizations, to operate with capital ratios substantially in excess of the stated ratios required to maintain “well capitalized” status. This has resulted from, among other things, current economic conditions, the global financial crisis and the likelihood, as described below, of increased formal capital requirements for banking organizations. In light of the foregoing, the Company and the bank expect that they will maintain capital ratios substantially in excess of these ratios.

The elements currently comprising Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital, the minimum Tier 1 capital and total capital ratios and the minimum leverage ratio may in the future be subject to change, as discussed in greater detail under the caption “BUSINESS—SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” beginning on page 3.

IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CHANGING PRICES

The Company’s financial statements included herein have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which require the Company to measure financial position and operating results primarily in terms of historical dollars. Changes in the relative value of money due to inflation or recession are generally not considered. The primary effect of inflation on the operations of the Company is reflected in increased operating costs. In management’s opinion, changes in interest rates affect the financial condition of a financial institution to a far greater degree than changes in the inflation rate. While interest rates are greatly influenced by changes in the inflation rate, they do not necessarily change at the same rate or in the same magnitude as the inflation rate. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond the control of the Company, including changes in the expected rate of inflation, the influence of general and local economic conditions and the monetary and fiscal policies of the United States government, its agencies and various other governmental regulatory authorities, among other things, as further discussed under the caption “RISKS RELATED TO THE COMPANY’S BUSINESS” beginning on page 17 and under the caption “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” beginning on page 52.

RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

See “Adoption of New Accounting Standards” and “Newly Issued Not Yet Effective Standards” in Note 1 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements for information regarding recently issued accounting pronouncements and their expected impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

PAGE 55


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED INTEREST RATE SENSITIVITY

To mitigate the vulnerability of earnings to changes in interest rates, the Company manages the repricing characteristics of assets and liabilities in an attempt to control net interest rate sensitivity. Management attempts to confine significant rate sensitivity gaps predominantly to repricing intervals of a year or less, so that adjustments can be made quickly. Assets and liabilities with predetermined repricing dates are classified based on the earliest repricing period. Based on the interest rate sensitivity analysis shown below, the Company’s net interest income would increase during periods of rising interest rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Repricing Date

 

 

 


 

 

 

3 Months
or Less

 

More than
3 Months
to 1 Year

 

1 Year to
5 Years

 

5 Years to
10 Years

 

Over
10 Years

 

Nonrate
Sensitive

 

Total

 

















ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

$

40,503

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

40,503

 

Investment securities

 

 

60,537

 

 

172,562

 

 

196,397

 

 

80,235

 

 

279,584

 

 

 

 

789,315

 

Commercial and industrial loans

 

 

460,249

 

 

71,388

 

 

84,856

 

 

3,278

 

 

365

 

 

(1,913

)

 

618,223

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

748

 

 

10,698

 

 

80,527

 

 

64,840

 

 

4,241

 

 

(16,819

)

 

144,235

 

Factored receivables

 

 

162,070

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(281

)

 

161,789

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

19,498

 

 

32,452

 

 

17,976

 

 

29,492

 

 

60,326

 

 

 

 

159,744

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

14,142

 

 

30,140

 

 

35,247

 

 

17,462

 

 

 

 

 

 

96,991

 

Real estate—construction loans

 

 

7,872

 

 

5,017

 

 

9,150

 

 

3,585

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,624

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

9,335

 

 

792

 

 

1,243

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,370

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

101,614

 

 

10,000

 

 

1,268

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

112,882

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

15,425

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,425

 

Noninterest-earning assets and allowance for loan losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

184,356

 

 

184,356

 

 

 






















Total Assets

 

 

891,993

 

 

333,049

 

 

426,664

 

 

198,892

 

 

344,516

 

 

165,343

 

 

2,360,457

 

 

 






















LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Savings

 

 

 

 

 

 

18,931

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

18,931

 

NOW

 

 

 

 

 

 

200,521

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

200,521

 

Money market

 

 

267,745

 

 

 

 

75,010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

342,755

 

Time—domestic

 

 

176,070

 

 

387,194

 

 

51,912

 

 

91

 

 

 

 

 

 

615,267

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

23,016

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

23,016

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,000

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

15,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,000

 

Commercial paper

 

 

14,288

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

14,388

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

3,490

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,490

 

Advances—FHLB

 

 

15,000

 

 

15,000

 

 

94,173

 

 

20,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

144,173

 

Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,774

 

 

 

 

25,774

 

Noninterest-bearing liabilities and shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

952,142

 

 

952,142

 

 

 






















Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

 

 

514,609

 

 

402,294

 

 

445,547

 

 

20,091

 

 

25,774

 

 

952,142

 

 

2,360,457

 

 

 






















Net Interest Rate Sensitivity Gap

 

$

377,384

 

$

(69,245

)

$

(18,883

)

$

178,801

 

$

318,742

 

$

(786,799

)

$

 

 

 






















Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2010

 

$

377,384

 

$

308,139

 

$

289,256

 

$

468,057

 

$

786,799

 

$

 

$

 

 

 






















Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2009

 

$

215,345

 

$

223,572

 

$

238,762

 

$

348,921

 

$

707,012

 

$

 

$

 

 

 






















Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2008

 

$

(1,506

)

$

(119,864

)

$

(67,838

)

$

121,095

 

$

620,719

 

$

 

$

 

 

 























PAGE 56


ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

The Company’s consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2010, and the statements of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, notes thereto and the Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms thereon appear on pages 58–115.

 

PAGE 57


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







 

 

(dollars in thousands,
except per share data)

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks

 

$

26,824

 

$

24,911

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

 

40,503

 

 

36,958

 

Securities available for sale (at estimated fair value; pledged: $95,311 in 2010 and $150,034 in 2009)

 

 

390,080

 

 

346,526

 

Securities held to maturity (pledged: $212,606 in 2010 and $278,598 in 2009) (estimated fair value: $400,453 in 2010 and $396,150 in 2009)

 

 

399,235

 

 

390,539

 

 

 






 

Total investment securities

 

 

789,315

 

 

737,065

 

 

 






 

Loans held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

 

33,889

 

 

Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

1,314,234

 

 

1,195,415

 

Less allowance for loan losses

 

 

18,238

 

 

19,872

 

 

 






 

Loans, net

 

 

1,295,996

 

 

1,175,543

 

 

 






 

Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost

 

 

9,365

 

 

8,482

 

Customers’ liability under acceptances

 

 

 

 

27

 

Goodwill

 

 

22,901

 

 

22,901

 

Premises and equipment, net

 

 

15,909

 

 

9,658

 

Other real estate

 

 

182

 

 

1,385

 

Accrued interest receivable

 

 

8,280

 

 

9,001

 

Cash surrender value of life insurance policies

 

 

51,512

 

 

49,009

 

Other assets

 

 

67,621

 

 

56,780

 

 

 






 

Total assets

 

$

2,360,457

 

$

2,165,609

 

 

 






 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

$

570,290

 

$

546,337

 

Savings, NOW and money market deposits

 

 

562,207

 

 

592,015

 

Time deposits

 

 

615,267

 

 

442,315

 

 

 






 

Total deposits

 

 

1,747,764

 

 

1,580,667

 

 

 






 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

23,016

 

 

21,048

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

5,000

 

 

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

15,000

 

 

41,000

 

Commercial paper

 

 

14,388

 

 

17,297

 

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

 

 

50,000

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

3,490

 

 

2,509

 

Advances—FHLB

 

 

144,173

 

 

130,000

 

Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures

 

 

25,774

 

 

25,774

 

 

 






 

Total borrowings

 

 

230,841

 

 

287,628

 

 

 






 

Acceptances outstanding

 

 

 

 

27

 

Accrued interest payable

 

 

1,314

 

 

1,291

 

Due to factored clients

 

 

91,543

 

 

82,401

 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

 

66,253

 

 

51,645

 

 

 






 

Total liabilities

 

 

2,137,715

 

 

2,003,659

 

 

 






 

Commitments and contingent liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock, Series A, $5 par value; $1,000 liquidation value. Authorized 644,389 shares; issued 42,000 shares

 

 

40,602

 

 

40,113

 

Common stock, $1 par value. Authorized 50,000,000 shares; issued 31,138,545 and 22,226,425 shares, respectively

 

 

31,139

 

 

22,227

 

Warrant to purchase common stock

 

 

2,615

 

 

2,615

 

Capital surplus

 

 

236,437

 

 

178,734

 

Retained earnings

 

 

11,392

 

 

15,828

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

 

(12,887

)

 

(12,399

)

 

Common stock in treasury at cost, 4,297,782 and 4,119,934 shares, respectively

 

 

(86,556

)

 

(85,168

)

 

 






 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

 

222,742

 

 

161,950

 

 

 






 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

 

$

2,360,457

 

$

2,165,609

 

 

 






 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 58


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

 

INTEREST INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans

 

$

70,104

 

$

71,788

 

$

80,445

 

Investment securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available for sale—taxable

 

 

10,863

 

 

16,575

 

 

20,453

 

Held to maturity—taxable

 

 

10,879

 

 

15,070

 

 

15,718

 

Tax exempt

 

 

4,824

 

 

1,889

 

 

811

 

Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

 

445

 

 

513

 

 

594

 

Federal funds sold

 

 

 

 

 

 

8

 

Deposits with other banks

 

 

75

 

 

85

 

 

42

 

 

 









 

Total interest income

 

 

97,190

 

 

105,920

 

 

118,071

 

 

 









 

INTEREST EXPENSE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Savings, NOW and Money Market

 

 

3,288

 

 

3,890

 

 

6,403

 

Time

 

 

6,300

 

 

7,999

 

 

15,105

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

229

 

 

353

 

 

1,855

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

44

 

 

 

 

1,127

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

74

 

 

51

 

 

899

 

Commercial paper

 

 

45

 

 

67

 

 

461

 

Short-term borrowings—FHLB

 

 

 

 

11

 

 

1,309

 

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

9

 

 

398

 

 

47

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

18

 

 

 

 

35

 

Advances—FHLB

 

 

3,482

 

 

4,432

 

 

4,053

 

Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures

 

 

2,094

 

 

2,094

 

 

2,094

 

 

 









 

Total interest expense

 

 

15,583

 

 

19,295

 

 

33,388

 

 

 









 

Net interest income

 

 

81,607

 

 

86,625

 

 

84,683

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

28,500

 

 

27,900

 

 

8,325

 

 

 









 

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

53,107

 

 

58,725

 

 

76,358

 

 

 









 

NONINTEREST INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees

 

 

23,572

 

 

18,320

 

 

15,713

 

Service charges on deposit accounts

 

 

6,250

 

 

5,943

 

 

5,418

 

Trade finance income

 

 

2,264

 

 

1,891

 

 

1,670

 

Other customer related service charges and fees

 

 

777

 

 

929

 

 

1,121

 

Mortgage banking income

 

 

8,164

 

 

9,476

 

 

8,619

 

Trust fees

 

 

329

 

 

450

 

 

571

 

Income from life insurance policies

 

 

1,138

 

 

1,098

 

 

1,127

 

Securities gains

 

 

3,928

 

 

5,561

 

 

 

Other-than-temporary impairment loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,684

)

Loss on other real estate owned

 

 

(64

)

 

(32

)

 

(326

)

Other income

 

 

1,275

 

 

514

 

 

1,071

 

 

 









 

Total noninterest income

 

 

47,633

 

 

44,150

 

 

33,300

 

 

 









 

NONINTEREST EXPENSES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Salaries

 

 

41,586

 

 

39,875

 

 

38,523

 

Employee benefits

 

 

12,220

 

 

12,293

 

 

9,893

 

 

 









 

Total personnel expense

 

 

53,806

 

 

52,168

 

 

48,416

 

Occupancy and equipment expenses, net

 

 

12,296

 

 

11,278

 

 

11,365

 

Advertising and marketing

 

 

3,381

 

 

3,167

 

 

3,914

 

Professional fees

 

 

5,464

 

 

5,147

 

 

7,873

 

Communications

 

 

1,691

 

 

1,665

 

 

1,757

 

Deposit insurance

 

 

3,809

 

 

4,153

 

 

751

 

Other expenses

 

 

11,109

 

 

10,967

 

 

10,400

 

 

 









 

Total noninterest expenses

 

 

91,556

 

 

88,545

 

 

84,476

 

 

 









 

Income before income taxes

 

 

9,184

 

 

14,330

 

 

25,182

 

Provision for income taxes

 

 

2,158

 

 

4,908

 

 

9,176

 

 

 









 

Net income

 

 

7,026

 

 

9,422

 

 

16,006

 

Dividends on preferred shares and accretion

 

 

2,589

 

 

2,773

 

 

102

 

 

 









 

Net income available to common shareholders

 

$

4,437

 

$

6,649

 

$

15,904

 

 

 









 

Average number of common shares outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

24,492,279

 

 

18,104,619

 

 

17,890,997

 

Diluted

 

 

24,495,044

 

 

18,126,333

 

 

18,107,878

 

Net income available to common shareholders, per average common share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

0.18

 

$

0.37

 

$

0.89

 

Diluted

 

 

0.18

 

 

0.37

 

 

0.88

 

Dividends per common share

 

 

0.36

 

 

0.56

 

 

0.76

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 59


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

Net income

 

$

7,026

 

$

9,422

 

$

16,006

 

 

 










Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized holding gains on available for sale securities and other investments, arising during the year

 

 

2,101

 

 

3,039

 

 

360

 

Reclassification adjustment for (gains) losses included in net income

 

 

(2,145

)

 

(3,037

)

 

920

 

Pension liability adjustment—net actuarial (losses) gains

 

 

(1,940

)

 

1,935

 

 

(7,613

)

Reclassification adjustment for amortization of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Prior service cost

 

 

36

 

 

36

 

 

36

 

Net actuarial losses

 

 

1,460

 

 

1,887

 

 

850

 

 

 










Other comprehensive (loss) income

 

 

(488

)

 

3,860

 

 

(5,447

)

 

 










Comprehensive income

 

$

6,538

 

$

13,282

 

$

10,559

 

 

 










See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 60


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF
CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

PREFERRED STOCK

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

40,113

 

$

39, 440

 

$

 

Allocated proceeds at issuance

 

 

 

 

 

 

39,385

 

Discount accretion

 

 

489

 

 

673

 

 

55

 

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

40,602

 

$

40,113

 

$

39,440

 

 

 










COMMON STOCK

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

22,227

 

$

22,203

 

$

21,279

 

Common shares issued—public offering

 

 

8,625

 

 

 

 

 

Common shares issued under stock incentive plan

 

 

287

 

 

24

 

 

924

 

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

31,139

 

$

22,227

 

$

22,203

 

 

 










WARRANT TO PURCHASE COMMON STOCK

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

2,615

 

$

2,615

 

$

 

Allocated proceeds at issuance

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,615

 

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

2,615

 

$

2,615

 

$

2,615

 

 

 










CAPITAL SURPLUS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

178,734

 

$

178,417

 

$

168,869

 

Common shares issued—public offering

 

 

56,256

 

 

 

 

 

Common shares issued under stock incentive plan and related tax benefits

 

 

1,190

 

 

185

 

 

9,501

 

Stock option compensation expense

 

 

257

 

 

132

 

 

132

 

Issuance costs for Series A preferred stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

(85

)

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

236,437

 

$

178,734

 

$

178,417

 

 

 










RETAINED EARNINGS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year, as originally reported

 

$

15,828

 

$

19,088

 

$

17,538

 

Effect of change in accounting for bank-owned life insurance, effective January 1, 2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

(726

)

 

 










Balance at beginning of year, as adjusted

 

 

15,828

 

 

19,088

 

 

16,812

 

Net income

 

 

7,026

 

 

9,422

 

 

16,006

 

Cash dividends paid—common shares

 

 

(8,873

)

 

(10,131

)

 

(13,675

)

Cash dividends paid—preferred shares

 

 

(2,100

)

 

(1,878

)

 

 

Discount accretion on Series A preferred stock

 

 

(489

)

 

(673

)

 

(55

)

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

11,392

 

$

15,828

 

$

19,088

 

 

 










ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

(12,399

)

$

(16,259

)

$

(10,812

)

Other comprehensive (loss)/income, net of tax

 

 

(488

)

 

3,860

 

 

(5,447

)

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

(12,887

)

$

(12,399

)

$

(16,259

)

 

 










TREASURY STOCK

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

(85,168

)

$

(85,024

)

$

(75,803

)

Surrender of shares issued under stock incentive plan

 

 

(1,388

)

 

(144

)

 

(9,221

)

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

(86,556

)

$

(85,168

)

$

(85,024

)

 

 










TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

161,950

 

$

160,480

 

$

121,071

 

Net changes during the year

 

 

60,792

 

 

1,470

 

 

39,409

 

 

 










Balance at end of year

 

$

222,742

 

$

161,950

 

$

160,480

 

 

 










See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 61


Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









 

 

(dollars in thousands)

 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

7,026

 

$

9,422

 

$

16,006

 

Adjustments to reconcile income from continuing operations to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

28,500

 

 

27,900

 

 

8,325

 

Depreciation and amortization of premises and equipment

 

 

2,436

 

 

2,195

 

 

2,476

 

Securities gains

 

 

(3,928

)

 

(5,561

)

 

 

Other-than-temporary loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,684

 

Income from life insurance policies, net

 

 

(1,135

)

 

(1,388

)

 

(939

)

Deferred income tax (benefit) expense

 

 

(2,430

)

 

(6,344

)

 

1,181

 

Proceeds from sale of loans

 

 

493,147

 

 

618,857

 

 

452,310

 

Gains on sales of loans, net

 

 

(8,176

)

 

(9,480

)

 

(8,587

)

Originations of loans held for sale

 

 

(484,395

)

 

(619,863

)

 

(447,755

)

Amortization of premiums on investment securities

 

 

6,993

 

 

2,269

 

 

406

 

Accretion of discounts on investment securities

 

 

(559

)

 

(1,350

)

 

(628

)

Decrease (Increase) in accrued interest receivable

 

 

721

 

 

(85

)

 

(1,791

)

Increase (Decrease) in accrued interest payable

 

 

23

 

 

(755

)

 

(1,525

)

Increase in due to factored clients

 

 

9,142

 

 

31,780

 

 

3,493

 

Increase (Decrease) in accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

 

8,742

 

 

(10,150

)

 

(4,798

)

Increase in other assets

 

 

(8,552

)

 

(7,249

)

 

(6,659

)

Loss on OREO

 

 

64

 

 

32

 

 

326

 

 

 










Net cash provided by operating activities

 

 

47,619

 

 

30,230

 

 

13,525

 

 

 










INVESTING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchase of premises and equipment

 

 

(8,687

)

 

(1,149

)

 

(1,965

)

Net increase in interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

 

(3,545

)

 

(23,009

)

 

(12,969

)

Net (increase) decrease in loans held in portfolio

 

 

(126,361

)

 

13,778

 

 

(28,002

)

Net increase in short-term factored receivables

 

 

(21,862

)

 

(30,729

)

 

(9,139

)

Decrease in other real estate

 

 

1,672

 

 

2,196

 

 

2,136

 

Proceeds from calls/sales of securities—available for sale

 

 

486,191

 

 

395,632

 

 

34,555

 

Proceeds from calls of securities—held to maturity

 

 

142,380

 

 

40,000

 

 

 

Proceeds from prepayments, redemptions or maturities of securities—held to maturity

 

 

64,327

 

 

82,059

 

 

60,673

 

Proceeds from redemptions of Federal Home Loan Bank Stock

 

 

977

 

 

4,725

 

 

16,556

 

Purchases of securities—held to maturity

 

 

(209,964

)

 

(211,552

)

 

 

Proceeds from prepayments, redemptions or maturities—available for sale

 

 

210,749

 

 

132,043

 

 

153,264

 

Purchases of securities—available for sale

 

 

(744,344

)

 

(378,790

)

 

(404,512

)

Purchases of Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

 

(1,860

)

 

(503

)

 

(22,770

)

Cash paid in acquisition

 

 

 

 

(21,333

)

 

 

 

 










Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities

 

 

(210,327

)

 

3,368

 

 

(212,173

)

 

 










FINANCING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

 

23,953

 

 

81,752

 

 

(36,438

)

Net (decrease) increase in savings, NOW, money market deposits

 

 

(29,808

)

 

27,810

 

 

96,759

 

Net increase (decrease) in time deposits

 

 

172,952

 

 

113,281

 

 

(195,155

)

Net (decrease) increase in Federal funds purchased

 

 

(26,000

)

 

(90,000

)

 

66,000

 

Net increase (decrease) in securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

 

6,968

 

 

(23,286

)

 

(25,920

)

Net (decrease) increase in commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

 

 

(51,928

)

 

(118,264

)

 

117,906

 

Increase (Decrease) in long-term borrowings

 

 

14,173

 

 

(20,000

)

 

110,000

 

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

 

403

 

 

197

 

 

2,589

 

Proceeds from issuance of preferred shares and warrant to purchase common shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

42,000

 

Proceeds from issuance of common stock

 

 

64,881

 

 

 

 

 

Cash dividends paid on common shares

 

 

(8,873

)

 

(10,131

)

 

(13,674

)

Cash dividends paid on preferred shares

 

 

(2,100

)

 

(1,878

)

 

 

 

 










Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

 

164,621

 

 

(40,519

)

 

164,067

 

 

 










Net increase (decrease) in cash and due from banks

 

 

1,913

 

 

(6,921

)

 

(34,581

)

Cash and due from banks—beginning of year

 

 

24,911

 

 

31,832

 

 

66,413

 

 

 










Cash and due from banks—end of year

 

$

26,824

 

$

24,911

 

$

31,832

 

 

 










Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest paid

 

$

15,559

 

$

20,051

 

$

34,920

 

Income taxes paid

 

 

4,011

 

 

5,759

 

 

9,245

 

Loans held for sale transferred to portfolio

 

 

1,264

 

 

 

 

3,619

 

Loans in portfolio transferred to other real estate

 

 

533

 

 

2,069

 

 

2,336

 

Due to brokers on purchases of securities available for sale

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,446

 

Due to brokers on purchases of securities held to maturity

 

 

4,998

 

 

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 62


Sterling National Bank
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CONDITION

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







 

 

(dollars in thousands,
except per share data)

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks

 

$

26,792

 

$

24,874

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

 

40,503

 

 

36,958

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities available for sale (at estimated fair value; pledged: $95,311 in 2010 and $150,034 in 2009)

 

 

383,994

 

 

345,548

 

Securities held to maturity (pledged: $212,606 in 2010 and $278,598 in 2009) (estimated fair value: $400,453 in 2010 and $396,150 in 2009)

 

 

399,235

 

 

390,539

 

 

 







Total investment securities

 

 

783,229

 

 

736,087

 

 

 







Loans held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

 

33,889

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

1,298,864

 

 

1,180,254

 

Less allowance for loan losses

 

 

18,238

 

 

19,872

 

 

 







Loans, net

 

 

1,280,626

 

 

1,160,382

 

 

 







Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan bank stock, at cost

 

 

9,365

 

 

8,482

 

Customers’ liability under acceptances

 

 

 

 

27

 

Goodwill

 

 

1,742

 

 

1,742

 

Premises and equipment, net

 

 

15,902

 

 

9,646

 

Other real estate

 

 

182

 

 

1,385

 

Accrued interest receivable

 

 

8,109

 

 

9,000

 

Cash surrender value of life insurance policies

 

 

47,408

 

 

45,249

 

Other assets

 

 

73,133

 

 

59,741

 

 

 







Total assets

 

$

2,319,040

 

$

2,127,462

 

 

 







LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER’S EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

 

$

607,914

 

$

549,414

 

Savings, NOW and money market deposits

 

 

565,653

 

 

620,281

 

Time deposits

 

 

615,267

 

 

442,315

 

 

 







Total deposits

 

 

1,788,834

 

 

1,612,010

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

23,016

 

 

21,048

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

5,000

 

 

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

15,000

 

 

41,000

 

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

 

 

50,000

 

Short-term borrowings—other

 

 

3,490

 

 

2,509

 

Advances—FHLB

 

 

144,173

 

 

130,000

 

Acceptances outstanding

 

 

 

 

27

 

Accrued interest payable

 

 

1,306

 

 

1,282

 

Due to factored clients

 

 

91,543

 

 

82,401

 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

 

61,018

 

 

43,195

 

 

 







Total liabilities

 

 

2,133,380

 

 

1,983,472

 

 

 







Commitments and contingent liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholder’s Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common stock, $50 par value; Authorized and issued, 358,526 shares

 

 

17,926

 

 

17,926

 

Capital surplus

 

 

51,263

 

 

19,763

 

Undivided profits

 

 

125,983

 

 

115,270

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

 

(9,512

)

 

(8,969

)

 

 







Total shareholder’s equity

 

 

185,660

 

 

143,990

 

 

 







Total liabilities and shareholder’s equity

 

$

2,319,040

 

$

2,127,462

 

 

 







See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

PAGE 63


Sterling Bancorp
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1.

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Sterling Bancorp (the “parent company”) is a financial holding company, pursuant to an election made under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999. Throughout the notes, the term the “Company” refers to Sterling Bancorp and its subsidiaries and the term the “bank” refers to Sterling National Bank and its subsidiaries. The Company provides a full range of financial products and services, including business and consumer loans, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, asset-based financing, factoring/accounts receivable management services, trade financing, equipment financing, and deposit services. The Company has operations principally in New York and conducts business throughout the United States.

The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”), which, effective for all interim and annual periods ending after September 15, 2009, principally consist of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“Codification”). FASB Codification Topic 105: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles establishes the FASB Codification as the source of authoritative accounting principles recognized by the FASB to be applied by nongovernmental entities in the preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. Rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), under authority of federal securities laws, are also sources of authoritative guidance for SEC registrants. All guidance contained in the FASB Codification carries an equal level of authority. All non-grandfathered, non-SEC accounting literature not included in the FASB Codification is superseded and deemed non-authoritative.

The following summarizes the significant accounting policies of the Company with specific references to the FASB Codification.

(a) Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the parent company and its subsidiaries, principally the bank, after elimination of intercompany transactions.

Generally, U.S. GAAP requires that all entities in which a company has a controlling financial interest be consolidated. The Company determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether it holds ownership of a majority voting interest. However, certain entities may not have voting interests or decision-making abilities because the controlling financial interest is achieved through other arrangements. These variable interest entities (“VIEs”) may still require consolidation even though equity investors do not have the typical characteristics of a controlling financial interest or do not have sufficient equity at risk for the legal entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support. A controlling financial interest in a VIE is present when an enterprise has a variable interest, or a combination of variable interests, that will absorb a majority of the entity’s expected losses, receive a majority of the entity’s expected residual returns, or both. The enterprise with a controlling financial interest, known as the primary beneficiary, consolidates the VIE. The parent company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, Sterling Bancorp Trust I, is a VIE for which the Company is not the primary beneficiary. Accordingly, the accounts of this entity are not included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

(b) General Accounting Policies

The preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP requires management to make assumptions and estimates which impact the amounts reported in those statements and are, by their nature, subject to change in the future as additional information becomes available or as circumstances vary. Actual results could differ from management’s current estimates, as a result of changing conditions and future events. The current economic environment has increased the degree of uncertainty inherent in these significant estimates. Several accounting estimates are particularly critical and are susceptible to significant near-term change, including the allowance for loan losses and asset impairment judgments, such as other-than-temporary declines in the value of securities and the accounting for income taxes. The judgments used by management in applying these critical accounting policies may be affected by a further and prolonged deterioration or lack of significant improvement in the economic environment, which may result in changes to future financial results. For example, subsequent evaluations of the loan portfolio, in light of the factors then prevailing, may result in significant changes in the allowance for loan losses in future periods, and the inability to collect outstanding principal may result in increased loan losses.

The Company evaluates subsequent events through the date that the financial statements are issued.

Certain reclassifications have been made to the prior years’ consolidated financial statements to conform to the current presentation. Throughout the notes, dollar amounts presented in tables are in thousands, except per share data.

PAGE 64


(c) Adoption of New Accounting Standards

In June 2009, the FASB amended guidance for consolidation of variable interest entity guidance by replacing the quantitative-based risks and rewards calculation for determining which enterprise, if any, has a controlling financial interest in a variable interest entity with an approach focused on identifying which enterprise has the power to direct the activities of a variable interest entity that most significantly impact the entity’s economic performance and (1) the obligation to absorb losses of the entity or (2) the right to receive benefits from the entity. Additional disclosures about an enterprise’s involvement in VIEs are also required. This guidance is effective as of the beginning of each reporting entity’s first annual reporting period that begins after November 15, 2009, for interim periods within that first annual reporting period, and for interim and annual reporting periods thereafter. Early adoption is prohibited. The effect of adopting this new guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

In January 2010, FASB issued guidance that requires expanded disclosures related to fair value measurements including (i) the amounts of significant transfers of assets or liabilities between Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy and the reasons for the transfers (ii) the reasons for transfers of assets or liabilities in or out of Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, which significant transfers disclosed separately, (iii) the policy for determining when transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy are recognized and (iv) for recurring fair value measurements of assets and liabilities in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, a gross presentation of information about purchases, sales, issuances and settlements. The guidance further clarifies that (i) fair value measurement disclosures should be provided for each class of assets and liabilities (rather than major category), which would generally be a subset of assets or liabilities within a line in statement of financial position and (ii) companies should provide disclosures about the valuation techniques and inputs used to measure fair value for both recurring and nonrecurring fair value measurements for each class of assets and liabilities included in Levels 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The disclosures related to the gross presentation of purchases, sales, issuances and settlements of assets and liabilities included in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are required for the Company beginning January 1, 2011. The remaining disclosure requirements and clarifications made by ASU 2010-06 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2010. The effect of adopting this new guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

In March 2010, FASB issued guidance that clarifies that the only form of an embedded credit derivative that is exempt from the embedded derivative bifurcation requirements are those that relate to the subordination of one financial instrument to another. As a result, entities that have contracts containing an embedded credit derivative feature in a form other than such subordination may need to separately account for the embedded credit derivative feature. The provisions of this guidance became effective for the Company on July 1, 2010 and did not have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements.

In July 2010, FASB issued guidance that requires entities to provide disclosures designed to facilitate financial statement users’ evaluation of (i) the nature of credit risk inherent in the entity’s portfolio of financing receivables, (ii) how that risk is analyzed and assessed in arriving at the allowance for credit losses and (iii) the changes and reasons for those changes in the allowance for credit losses. Disclosures must be disaggregated by portfolio segment, the level at which an entity develops and documents a systematic method for determining its allowance for credit losses, and class of financing receivables, which is generally a disaggregation of portfolio segment. The required disclosures include, among other things, a roll-forward of the allowance for credit losses as well as information about modified, impaired, nonaccrual and past due loans and credit quality indicators. This guidance became effective for the Company’s financial statements as of December 31, 2010, as it relates to disclosures required as of the end of a reporting period. Disclosures that relate to activity during a reporting period will be required for the Company’s financial statements that include periods beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

(d) Newly Issued Not Yet Effective Standards

In December 2010, FASB issued guidance that modifies Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test for reporting units with zero or negative carrying amounts. For those reporting units, an entity is required to perform Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test if it is more likely than not that a goodwill impairment exists. In determining whether it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists, an entity should consider whether there are any adverse qualitative factors indicating that an impairment may exist. The qualitative factors are consistent with the existing guidance which requires that goodwill of a reporting unit be tested for impairment between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying amount.

PAGE 65


The provisions of this guidance will be effective for the Company for fiscal year and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2010. Early adoption is not permitted. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

In December 2010, FASB issued guidance that specifies that if a public entity presents comparative financial statements, the entity should disclose revenue and earnings of the combined entity as though the business combination(s) that occurred during the current year had occurred as of the beginning of the comparable prior annual reporting period only. This guidance also expands the supplemental pro forma disclosures to include a description of the nature and amount of material, nonrecurring pro forma adjustments directly attributed to the business combination included in the reported pro forma revenue and earnings. The provisions of this guidance will be effective prospectively for business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

In January 2011, FASB issued guidance that temporarily delays the effective date of the disclosures about troubled debt restructuring for public entities. The delay is intended to allow the Board time to complete its deliberations on what constitutes a troubled debt restructuring. The effective date of the new disclosures about troubled debt restructurings for public entities and the guidance for determining what constitutes a troubled debt restructuring will then be coordinated. Currently, that guidance is anticipated to be effective for interim and annual periods ending after June 15, 2011.

(e) Investment Securities

Securities are designated at the time of acquisition as available for sale or held to maturity. Securities that the Company will hold for indefinite periods of time and that might be sold in the future as part of efforts to manage interest rate risk or in response to changes in interest rates, changes in prepayment risk, changes in market conditions or changes in economic factors are classified as available for sale and carried at estimated fair values. Net aggregate unrealized gains or losses are reported, net of taxes, as a component of shareholders’ equity through other comprehensive income. Securities that the Company has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are designated as held to maturity and are carried at amortized cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts over the period to maturity. Interest income includes the amortization of purchase premiums and accretion of purchase discounts. Gains and losses realized on sales of securities are determined on the specific identification method and are reported in noninterest income.

Securities pledged as collateral are disclosed parenthetically in the Consolidated Balance Sheets if the secured party has the right by contract or custom to sell or repledge the collateral. Securities are pledged by the Company to secure trust and public deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, advances from the FHLB and for other purposes required or permitted by law.

A periodic review is conducted by management to determine if the decline in the fair value of any security appears to be other-than-temporary. Factors considered in determining whether the decline is other-than-temporary include, but are not limited to: the length of time and the extent to which fair value has been below cost; the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer; and the Company’s intent to sell. If the decline is deemed to be other-than-temporary, and the Company does not have the intent to sell and will not likely be required to sell, the security is written down to a new cost basis and the resulting credit component of the loss is reported in noninterest income and the remainder of the loss is recorded in shareholders’ equity. If the Company intends to sell or will be required to sell, the full amount of the other-than-temporary impairment is recorded in noninterest income.

(f) Loans

Loans (including factored accounts receivable), other than those held for sale, are reported at their principal amount outstanding, net of unearned discounts and unamortized nonrefundable fees and direct costs associated with their origination or acquisition. Interest earned on loans is credited to income based on loan principal amounts outstanding at appropriate interest rates. Origination and other nonrefundable fees net of direct costs and discounts on loans (excluding factored accounts receivable) are credited to income over the terms of the loans using a method that results in an approximately constant effective yield. Nonrefundable fees on the purchase of accounts receivable are credited to “Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees” at the time of purchase, which, based on our analysis, does not produce results that are materially different from the results under the amortization method specified in FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables.

Mortgage loans held for sale, including deferred fees and costs, are reported at the lower of cost or fair value as determined

PAGE 66


by outstanding commitments from investors or current investor yield requirements calculated on the aggregate loan basis, and are included under the caption “Loans held for sale” in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized in a valuation allowance by a charge to income. Mortgage loans are sold, including servicing rights, without recourse. Gains or losses resulting from sales of mortgage loans, net of unamortized deferred fees and costs, are recognized when the proceeds are received from investors and are included under the caption “Mortgage banking income” in the Consolidated Statements of Income. In connection with its mortgage banking activities, the Company has commitments to fund loans held for sale and commitments to sell loans which are considered derivative instruments under FASB Codification Topic 815: Derivatives and Hedging. The fair values of these free-standing derivative instruments were immaterial at December 31, 2010 and 2009.

A loan is impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due according to the original contractual terms of the loan agreement. Loans, for which the terms have been modified, and for which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, are considered troubled debt restructurings and classified as impaired. Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, individually identified impaired loans are measured based on the present value of payments expected to be received, using the historical effective loan rate as the discount rate. Alternatively, measurement may also be based on observable market prices; or, for loans that are solely dependent on the collateral for repayment, measurement may be based on the fair value of the collateral. If the recorded investment in the impaired loan exceeds fair value, a valuation allowance is required as a component of the allowance for loan losses. Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectibility of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

Nonaccrual loans are those on which the accrual of interest has ceased. Loans, including loans that are individually identified as being impaired under FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, are generally placed on nonaccrual status immediately if, in the opinion of management, principal or interest is not likely to be paid in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, or when principal or interest is past due 90 days or more and collateral, if any, is insufficient to cover principal and interest. Interest accrued but not collected at the date a loan is placed on nonaccrual status is reversed against interest income. Interest income is recognized on nonaccrual loans only to the extent received in cash. However, where there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectibility of the loan principal, cash receipts, whether designated as principal or interest, are thereafter applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan. Loans are restored to accrual status only when interest and principal payments are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

(g) Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance for loan losses is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which represents management’s best estimate of losses that have been incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The allowance for loan losses includes allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies. Further information regarding the Company’s policies and methodology used to estimate the allowance for loan losses is presented in Note 6—Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses.

(h) Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank Stock

The bank is required to maintain a minimum level of investment in Federal Home Loan Bank of New York (“FHLB”) stock based on specific percentages of its outstanding mortgages, total assets or FHLB advances. FHLB and Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) stocks are restricted because they may only be sold to another member institution or the FHLB or FRB at their par values. Due to restrictive terms, and the lack of a readily determinable market value, FHLB and FRB stocks are shown separately in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, carried at cost and evaluated for ultimate recovery of par value.

(i) Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill, representing the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net assets of businesses acquired, reflected in the Consolidated Balance Sheets arose from the parent company’s acquisition of the bank (in 1968) and the acquisition of Sterling Resource Funding Corp (in 2006). Goodwill is assigned to the Corporate lending unit for segment reporting purposes. Effective January 1, 2002, the Company adopted the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 350: Intangibles—Goodwill and Other, under which goodwill is deemed to have an indefinite useful life, and therefore not amortized, and the Company is required to complete an annual assessment by segment for any impairment of goodwill. Impairment

PAGE 67


exists when a reporting unit’s carrying value of goodwill exceeds its fair value. The Company has selected December 31 as the date to perform the annual impairment testing. The impairment would be treated as an expense in the income statement. There was no impairment expense recorded in 2010, 2009 or 2008.

Goodwill is the only intangible asset with an indefinite life on our balance sheet and is tested for impairment using a two-step approach that initially involves the identification of “reporting units” and the estimation of their respective fair values. If the fair value of a reporting unit is less than the carrying value of the reporting unit, a goodwill impairment loss would be recognized as a charge to expense for any excess of the goodwill carrying amount over its implied fair value.

Other intangible assets consist of acquired customer contracts and assets arising from a purchase of assets as of April 6, 2009. They were initially measured at fair value and then are amortized on a straight-line method over their estimated useful life of 2 years.

(j) Premises and Equipment

Premises and equipment, excluding land, are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation or amortization as applicable. Land is reported at cost. Depreciation is computed on a straight-line basis and is charged to noninterest expense over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. Useful lives are 7 years for furniture fixtures and equipment, between 3 and 7 years for ATMs, computer hardware and software, and 10 years for building improvements. Amortization of leasehold improvements is charged to noninterest expense over the terms of the respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the improvements, whichever is shorter. Maintenance, repairs and minor improvements are charged to noninterest expenses as incurred.

(k) Foreclosed Assets

Assets acquired through or instead of loan foreclosure are held for sale and are initially recorded at fair value less estimated selling costs when acquired, establishing a new cost basis. Costs after acquisition are generally expensed. If the fair value of the asset declines, a write-down is recorded through expense. The valuation of foreclosed assets is subjective in nature and may be adjusted in the future because of changes in economic conditions.

(l) Cash Surrender Value of Life Insurance Policies

The bank invested in Bank Owned Life Insurance (“BOLI”) policies to fund certain future employee benefit costs. In addition, the parent company and the bank own endorsement split-dollar life insurance policies on certain key executives. The cash surrender value, net of surrender charges, of these insurance policies is recorded in the Consolidated Balance Sheets under the caption “Cash surrender value of bank owned and other life insurance policies.” Changes in the cash surrender value, net of surrender charges, of BOLI policies are recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income under the caption “Income from bank owned life insurance policies.” Changes in the cash surrender value, net of surrender charges, of the endorsement split-dollar life insurance policies are netted against premium expense in the Consolidated Statements of Income under the caption “Employee benefits.” As discussed more fully in Note 20 beginning on page 95, the Company adopted new accounting requirements related to bank-owned life insurance included in FASB Codification Topic 715: Compensation—Retirement Benefits on January 1, 2008 as a change in accounting principle through a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings.

(m) Repurchase Agreements

The Company sells certain securities under agreements to repurchase and receives cash as collateral. The agreements are treated as collateralized financing transactions and the obligations to repurchase securities sold are reflected as a liability in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The carrying value of the securities underlying the agreements remains reflected as an asset.

(n) Derivative Financial Instruments

The Company’s hedging policies permit the use of various derivative financial instruments to manage interest rate risk or to hedge specified assets and liabilities. All derivatives are recorded at fair value on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. To qualify for hedge accounting, derivatives must be highly effective at reducing the risk associated with the exposure being hedged and must be designated as a hedge at the inception of the derivative contract. The Company considers a hedge to be highly effective if the change in fair value of the derivative hedging instrument is within 80% to 120% of the opposite change in the fair value of the derivative and the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk. If derivative instruments are designated as hedges of fair values, and such hedges are highly effective, both the change in the fair value of the derivative and the hedged item are included in current earnings. Fair value adjustments related to cash flow hedges are recorded in other comprehensive income and are reclassified to earnings when the hedged transaction is reflected in

PAGE 68


earnings. Ineffective portions of hedges are reflected in earnings as they occur. Actual cash receipts and/or payments and related accruals on derivatives related to hedges are recorded as adjustments to the interest income or interest expense associated with the hedged item. During the life of the hedge, the Company formally assesses whether derivatives designated as hedging instruments continue to be highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of hedged items. If it is determined that a hedge has ceased to be highly effective, the Company will discontinue hedge accounting prospectively. At such time, previous adjustments to the carrying value of the hedged item are reversed into current earnings and the derivative instrument is reclassified to a trading position recorded at fair value. Changes in the fair value of derivative financial instruments not designated as hedges for accounting purposes are reflected in income or expense at measurement dates. At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company was not a party to any financial instrument derivative agreement.

The Company may be required to recognize certain contracts and commitments as derivatives when the characteristics of those contracts and commitments meet the definition of a derivative.

(o) Impact of Current Economic Conditions

Current economic conditions, including illiquid credit markets, volatile equity, foreign currency and energy markets, and reduced consumer spending, have combined to increase risk and uncertainty across industries. The Company considers the current economic conditions and their impact on the financial results and operations of the Company discussed above, including the determination of fair value of investment securities or derivative financial instruments the Company holds, the establishment of allowance for loan losses, the impairment of any asset and any other amounts reported in the financial statements of the Company that may be affected in the near term.

(p) Income Taxes

The Company utilizes the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes. Deferred income tax expense (benefit) is determined by recognizing deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. The realization of deferred tax assets is assessed and a valuation allowance provided for that portion of the assets for which it is more likely than not that it will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates and will be adjusted for the effects of future changes in tax laws or rates, if any.

For income tax purposes, the parent company files: a consolidated Federal income tax return; combined New York City and New York State income tax returns; and separate state income tax returns for its out-of-state subsidiaries. The parent company, under tax sharing agreements, either pays or collects current income taxes due to or due from its subsidiaries.

Starting in 2009, New York State tax law generally requires a REIT that is majority owned by a New York State bank to be included in the bank’s combined New York State tax return. The Company believes that it qualifies for the small-bank exception to this rule. If, contrary to this belief, Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. were required to be included in the Company’s New York State combined tax return, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.

Under the small-bank exception, dividends received by the bank from SREHC, a real estate investment trust, are subject to a 60% dividends-received deduction, which results in only 40% of the dividends being subject to New York State tax. Currently, the New York City banking corporation tax operates in the same manner in this respect. The possible reform of the New York State franchise and banking corporation tax laws mentioned under “ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS—RISKS RELATED TO THE COMPANY’S BUSINESS—Possible New York State Legislative Changes May Negatively Affect the Amount of Taxes We Pay in Future Years” could require SREHC to file a combined New York State return with the Company and substantially eliminate the benefit of the 60% dividends-received deduction by causing generally all of SREHC’s income to be subject to New York State tax as part of the Company’s combined return.

(q) Statements of Cash Flows

For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash and amounts due from banks. Net cash flows are reported for customer loan and deposit transactions, interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions, federal funds purchased and repurchase agreements.

(r) Stock Incentive Plan

At December 31, 2010, the Company had a stock-based employee compensation plan, which is described more fully in Note 19.

Employee stock options generally expire ten years from the date of grant and become non-forfeitable one year from date of grant, although if necessary to qualify to the maximum

PAGE 69


extent possible as incentive stock options, these options become exercisable in annual installments. Director non-qualified stock options generally expire five years from the date of grant and become non-forfeitable and become exercisable in four annual installments starting one year from the date of grant. Stock-based compensation is recognized in compensation expense as described more fully in Note 19 over the period from the date of grant to the date on which the options become non-forfeitable.

(s) Earnings Per Common Share

Earnings per common share is computed using the two-class method. Basic earnings per common share is computed by dividing net earnings allocated to common shareholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the applicable period, excluding participating securities. Participating securities include non-vested stock awards such as rewards of restricted shares of common shares. Non-vested stock awards are considered participating securities because holders of these securities receive non-forfeitable dividends at the same rate as holders of the Company’s common stock. Diluted earnings per common share is computed using the weighted-average number of shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive effect of stock compensation using the treasury stock method.

(t) Immaterial Corrections

Management has made an immaterial correction to the classification in prior years’ balance sheet of certain loan principal payments received from borrowers. Since a comparable amount of loan payments has been misclassified in earlier years, the correction also resulted in a decrease of approximately $2.6 million in net cash used in investing activities and an equal decrease in net cash provided by financing activities in 2008. The correction had no effect on the consolidated statements of income. The revisions to the financial statements were not considered material to any prior periods.

(u) Segments

Internal financial information is primarily reported and aggregated in three lines of business; corporate lending, real estate lending and company-wide treasury.

NOTE 2.

ACQUISITION

On April 6, 2009, Sterling Factors Corporation, a subsidiary of the bank, acquired substantially all of the assets and customer accounts of DCD Capital, LLC and DCD Trade Services, LLC for a cash price of $21.3 million. The acquired assets and customer accounts are included in a division of Sterling Factors Corporation under the name Sterling Trade Capital. As part of the purchase, an intangible asset related to the customer contracts and accounts acquired was created and valued at $1.1 million. This intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line method over the estimated 2-year life of the asset. At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the intangible asset had a carrying value of $138 thousand and $688 thousand, respectively.

NOTE 3.

CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS

The Company maintains deposits with other financial institutions in amounts that exceed federal deposit insurance coverage. Management regularly evaluates the credit risk associated with the counterparties to these transactions and believes that the Company is not exposed to any significant credit risks.

The bank is required to maintain average reserves, net of vault cash, on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank of New York against outstanding domestic deposits and certain other liabilities. The reserves maintained, which are reported in cash and due from banks, were $34.6 million and $35.6 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Average required reserves during 2010 and 2009 were $5.2 million for both years.

Beginning on October 9, 2008, the Federal Reserve started to pay interest on required reserve balances and excess balances. For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company received interest from the Federal Reserve amounting to $76 thousand and $87 thousand, respectively.

PAGE 70


NOTE 4.
MONEY MARKET INVESTMENTS

The Company’s money market investments include interest-bearing deposits with other banks and Federal funds sold. The following table presents information regarding money market investments.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 













Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31

—Balance

 

$

40,503

 

$

36,958

 

$

13,949

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

0.25

%

 

0.24

%

 

1.20

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

7 Days

 

 

5 Days

 

 

68 Days

 

During the year

—Maximum month-end balance

 

 

66,858

 

 

78,603

 

 

14,431

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

31,960

 

 

36,804

 

 

5,727

 

 

—Average interest rate earned

 

 

0.23

%

 

0.23

%

 

0.74

%

 

—Range of interest rates earned

 

 

0.06–1.50

%

 

0.06–0.25

%

 

0.05–4.21

%

 

 

 










Federal funds sold

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31

—Balance

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

During the year

—Maximum month-end balance

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,500

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

 

 

 

 

444

 

 

—Average interest rate earned

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.84

%

 

—Range of interest rates earned

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.00–3.00

%

 

 

 










PAGE 71


NOTE 5.

INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The amortized cost and fair value of securities available for sale are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

Amortized
Cost

 

Gross
Unrealized
Gains

 

Gross
Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 










 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

$

36,026

 

$

64

 

$

372

 

$

35,718

 

CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)

 

 

7,218

 

 

72

 

 

 

 

7,290

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

8,750

 

 

84

 

 

13

 

 

8,821

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

44

 

 

2

 

 

1

 

 

45

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

110

 

 

 

 

1

 

 

109

 

 

 












 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

52,148

 

 

222

 

 

387

 

 

51,983

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

30,087

 

 

77

 

 

 

 

30,164

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

 

59

 

 

9,941

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

49,964

 

 

132

 

 

110

 

 

49,986

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

10,000

 

 

31

 

 

 

 

10,031

 

 

 












 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

152,199

 

 

462

 

 

556

 

 

152,105

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

39,967

 

 

780

 

 

703

 

 

40,044

 

Single-issuer trust preferred securities

 

 

3,879

 

 

79

 

 

25

 

 

3,933

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

189,091

 

 

278

 

 

311

 

 

189,058

 

Other securities

 

 

5,039

 

 

1

 

 

100

 

 

4,940

 

 

 












 

Total

 

$

390,175

 

$

1,600

 

$

1,695

 

$

390,080

 

 

 












 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 














 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

2,882

 

$

 

$

5

 

$

2,877

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

 

5,563

 

 

171

 

 

 

 

5,734

 

CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)

 

 

9,181

 

 

 

 

133

 

 

9,048

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

21,055

 

 

868

 

 

71

 

 

21,852

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

10,321

 

 

299

 

 

 

 

10,620

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

6,807

 

 

351

 

 

1

 

 

7,157

 

 

 












 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

55,809

 

 

1,689

 

 

210

 

 

57,288

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

20,291

 

 

 

 

835

 

 

19,456

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

83,983

 

 

6

 

 

1,039

 

 

82,950

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

4,995

 

 

 

 

96

 

 

4,899

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

24,999

 

 

 

 

669

 

 

24,330

 

 

 












 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

190,077

 

 

1,695

 

 

2,849

 

 

188,923

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

22,820

 

 

1,061

 

 

17

 

 

23,864

 

Single-issuer trust preferred securities

 

 

4,878

 

 

 

 

395

 

 

4,483

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

127,900

 

 

1,382

 

 

82

 

 

129,200

 

Other securities

 

 

44

 

 

12

 

 

 

 

56

 

 

 












 

Total

 

$

345,719

 

$

4,150

 

$

3,343

 

$

346,526

 

 

 












 

PAGE 72


The carrying value and fair value of securities held to maturity are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

Carrying
Value

 

Gross
Unrealized
Gains

 

Gross
Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 










 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

7,504

 

$

349

 

$

 

$

7,853

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

 

11,704

 

 

572

 

 

 

 

12,276

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

70,001

 

 

4,292

 

 

 

 

74,293

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

40,583

 

 

1,931

 

 

 

 

42,514

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

4,943

 

 

605

 

 

 

 

5,548

 

 

 












 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

134,735

 

 

7,749

 

 

 

 

142,484

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

84,969

 

 

5

 

 

1,405

 

 

83,569

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

14,991

 

 

 

 

222

 

 

14,769

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

42,493

 

 

4

 

 

608

 

 

41,889

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

5,078

 

 

 

 

42

 

 

5,036

 

 

 












 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

282,266

 

 

7,758

 

 

2,277

 

 

287,747

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

116,969

 

 

118

 

 

4,381

 

 

112,706

 

 

 












 

Total

 

$

399,235

 

$

7,876

 

$

6,658

 

$

400,453

 

 

 












 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 














 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

10,863

 

$

339

 

$

 

$

11,202

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

 

16,964

 

 

573

 

 

 

 

17,537

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

103,821

 

 

4,329

 

 

2

 

 

108,148

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

61,095

 

 

2,005

 

 

 

 

63,100

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

5,989

 

 

501

 

 

 

 

6,490

 

 

 












 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

198,732

 

 

7,747

 

 

2

 

 

206,477

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

97,147

 

 

14

 

 

1,742

 

 

95,419

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

19,849

 

 

 

 

474

 

 

19,375

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

 

218

 

 

9,782

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

5,088

 

 

 

 

94

 

 

4,994

 

 

 












 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

330,816

 

 

7,761

 

 

2,530

 

 

336,047

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

59,473

 

 

737

 

 

357

 

 

59,853

 

Debt securities issued by foreign governments

 

 

250

 

 

 

 

 

 

250

 

 

 












 

Total

 

$

390,539

 

$

8,498

 

$

2,887

 

$

396,150

 

 

 












 

The Company invests principally in obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises and other investment-grade securities. The fair value of these investments fluctuates based on several factors, including credit quality and general interest rate changes. The Company determined that it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell any investments before anticipated recovery.

At December 31, 2010, approximately $105.0 million, representing approximately 13.30%, of the Company’s held to maturity and available for sale securities are comprised of securities issued by financial service companies/banks including single-issuer trust preferred securities (6 issuers), corporate debt (19 issuers) and equity securities (4 issuers). These investments may pose a higher risk of future impairment charges as result of a continued deterioration or lack of significant improvement of the U.S. economy. The Company would be required to recognize impairment charges on these securities if they suffer a decline in value

PAGE 73


that is considered other than temporary. Numerous factors, including lack of liquidity for re-sales of certain investment securities, absence of reliable pricing information for investment securities, adverse changes in business climate, adverse actions by regulators, or unanticipated changes in the competitive environment could have a negative effect on the Company’s investment portfolio and may result in other-than-temporary impairment on certain investment securities in future periods.

The following table presents information regarding securities available for sale with temporary unrealized losses for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less Than 12 Months

 

12 Months or Longer

 

Total

 

 

 






 

December 31, 2010

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 














 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)

 

$

30,494

 

$

372

 

$

 

$

 

$

30,494

 

$

372

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

7,269

 

 

13

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,269

 

 

13

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

28

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

 

 

28

 

 

1

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

110

 

 

1

 

 

 

 

 

 

110

 

 

1

 

 

 


















 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

37,901

 

 

387

 

 

 

 

 

 

37,901

 

 

387

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

9,941

 

 

59

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,941

 

 

59

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

9,875

 

 

110

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,875

 

 

110

 

 

 


















 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

57,717

 

 

556

 

 

 

 

 

 

57,717

 

 

556

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

18,716

 

 

703

 

 

 

 

 

 

18,716

 

 

703

 

Single-issuer trust preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,111

 

 

25

 

 

2,111

 

 

25

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

92,392

 

 

311

 

 

 

 

 

 

92,392

 

 

311

 

Other securities

 

 

4,900

 

 

100

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,900

 

 

100

 

 

 


















 

Total

 

$

173,725

 

$

1,670

 

$

2,111

 

$

25

 

$

175,836

 

$

1,695

 

 

 


















 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 




















 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)

 

$

2,877

 

$

5

 

$

 

$

 

$

2,877

 

$

5

 

CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)

 

 

4,926

 

 

91

 

 

4,122

 

 

42

 

 

9,048

 

 

133

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

2,057

 

 

71

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,057

 

 

71

 

Government National Mortgage Association

 

 

 

 

 

 

123

 

 

1

 

 

123

 

 

1

 

 

 


















 

Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

9,860

 

 

167

 

 

4,245

 

 

43

 

 

14,105

 

 

210

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

19,456

 

 

835

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,456

 

 

835

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

68,231

 

 

751

 

 

9,713

 

 

288

 

 

77,944

 

 

1,039

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

4,899

 

 

96

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,899

 

 

96

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

24,330

 

 

669

 

 

 

 

 

 

24,330

 

 

669

 

 

 


















 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

126,776

 

 

2,518

 

 

13,958

 

 

331

 

 

140,734

 

 

2,849

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

872

 

 

17

 

 

 

 

 

 

872

 

 

17

 

Single-issuer trust preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,540

 

 

395

 

 

3,540

 

 

395

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

23,575

 

 

82

 

 

 

 

 

 

23,575

 

 

82

 

 

 


















 

Total

 

$

151,223

 

$

2,617

 

$

17,498

 

$

726

 

$

168,721

 

$

3,343

 

 

 


















 

PAGE 74


At December 31, 2010, the Company held no security positions of issuers of obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises, obligations of states and political institutions and corporate debt securities, that were in an unrealized loss position for more than 12 months.

The following table presents information regarding available for sale single-issuer, trust preferred securities at December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TARP
Recipient

 

 

Credit
Rating

 

Amortized
Cost

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Gain
(Loss)

 















 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

Sterling Bancorp Trust I, 8.375%,
due 3/31/2032

 

 

Yes

 

 

NA

 

$

981

 

$

1,039

 

$

58

 

NPB Capital Trust II, 7.85%,
due 9/30/2032

 

 

Yes

 

 

NA

 

 

126

 

 

125

 

 

(1

)

VNB Capital Trust I, 7.75%,
due 12/15/2031

 

 

Yes*

 

 

BBB–

 

 

22

 

 

23

 

 

1

 

HSBC Finance, 6.875%,
due 1/30/2033,
owned by HSBC Group, PLC

 

 

No

 

 

A

 

 

740

 

 

761

 

 

21

 

Citigroup Capital VII, 7.125%,
due 7/31/2031

 

 

Yes*

 

 

BB+

 

 

1,508

 

 

1,491

 

$

(17

)

Fleet Capital Trust VIII, 7.20%,
due 3/15/2032,

 

 

No

 

 

BB+

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

owned by Bank of America Corporation

 

 

Yes*

 

 

 

 

 

502

 

 

494

 

 

(8

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 










Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

3,879

 

$

3,933

 

$

54

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 










*TARP obligation was repaid prior to December 31, 2010.

At December 31, 2010, the Company held 6 security positions of single-issuer bank trust preferred securities and 34 security positions of corporate debt securities issued by financial institutions all which are paying in accordance with their terms and have no deferrals of interest or other deferrals. In addition, management analyzes the performance of the issuers on a quarterly basis, including a review of the issuer’s most recent bank regulatory report to assess credit risk and the probability of impairment of the contractual cash flows of the applicable securities. Based upon management’s fourth quarter review, all of the issuers have maintained performance levels adequate to support the contractual cash flows of the securities.

As of December 31, 2010, management does not have the intent to sell any of the securities classified as available for sale in the tables above and believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell any such securities before recovery of cost.

During 2008, the Company recognized OTTI charges on 1 trust preferred security and 1 corporate debt security totaling $1.7 million which were included in noninterest income under the caption “Other-than-temporary impairment losses.” These securities were subsequently sold at a minimal gain.

PAGE 75


The following table presents information regarding securities held to maturity with temporary unrealized losses for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less Than 12 Months

 

12 Months or Longer

 

Total

 

 

 







December 31, 2010

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 

Fair
Value

 

Unrealized
Losses

 















Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Agency Notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

$

78,564

 

$

1,405

 

$

 

$

 

$

78,564

 

$

1,405

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

14,769

 

 

222

 

 

 

 

 

 

14,769

 

 

222

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

36,890

 

 

608

 

 

 

 

 

 

36,890

 

 

608

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

5,036

 

 

42

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,036

 

 

42

 

 

 



















Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

135,259

 

 

2,277

 

 

 

 

 

 

135,259

 

 

2,277

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

94,309

 

 

4,103

 

 

2,277

 

 

278

 

 

96,586

 

 

4,381

 

 

 



















Total

 

$

229,568

 

$

6,380

 

$

2,277

 

$

278

 

$

231,845

 

$

6,658

 

 

 



















 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 





















Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

$

 

$

 

$

459

 

$

2

 

$

459

 

$

2

 

 

 



















Total residential mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

459

 

 

2

 

 

459

 

 

2

 

Agency Notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

 

86,027

 

 

1,742

 

 

 

 

 

 

86,027

 

 

1,742

 

Federal Home Loan Bank

 

 

19,375

 

 

474

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,375

 

 

474

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

 

9,782

 

 

218

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,782

 

 

218

 

Federal Farm Credit Bank

 

 

4,994

 

 

94

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,994

 

 

94

 

 

 



















 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

120,178

 

 

2,528

 

 

459

 

 

2

 

 

120,637

 

 

2,530

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

16,478

 

 

357

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,478

 

 

357

 

 

 



















Total

 

$

136,656

 

$

2,885

 

$

459

 

$

2

 

$

137,115

 

$

2,887

 

 

 



















At December 31, 2010, the Company held 1 residential mortgaged-backed debt security, in the held to maturity portfolio, that was in an unrealized loss position for more than 12 months. This security was an obligation of a government sponsored enterprise which guarantees principal and interest payments. Management has concluded that the unrealized loss is due to changes in market interest rates and/or changes in securities markets which resulted from temporary illiquidity and/or uncertainty in those markets. Further, management has made an evaluation that the Company has the ability to hold this investment until maturity and, given its current intention to do so, anticipates that it will realize the full carrying value of its investment. As a result, the unrealized loss is deemed to be temporary.

Information regarding calls of held to maturity securities is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Proceeds

 

$

142,380

 

$

40,000

 

$

 

Gross gains

 

 

368

 

 

 

 

 

Gross losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

There were no sales of held to maturity securities in 2010, 2009 or 2008.

PAGE 76


Information regarding sales and/or calls of the available for sale securities is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds

 

$

169,517

 

$

233,026

 

$

2,555

 

Gross gains

 

 

3,703

 

 

5,445

 

 

 

Gross losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Calls:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds

 

 

316,674

 

 

162,606

 

 

32,000

 

Gross gains

 

 

145

 

 

116

 

 

 

Gross losses

 

 

288

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities are pledged to secure trust and public deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York and/or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, and for other purposes required or permitted by law.

NOTE 6.

LOANS AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES

The major components of domestic loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 









Loans held for sale, net of valuation reserve ($113 at December 31, 2010 and $7 at December 31, 2009)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

$

32,049

 

$

33,889

 

 

 







Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

 

620,136

 

 

551,447

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

161,054

 

 

219,198

 

Factored receivables

 

 

162,070

 

 

140,265

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

127,695

 

 

124,681

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

96,991

 

 

92,614

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

25,624

 

 

24,277

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

11,370

 

 

12,984

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

15,425

 

 

20,000

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

112,882

 

 

35,591

 

 

 







Loans held in portfolio, gross

 

 

1,333,247

 

 

1,221,057

 

Less unearned discounts

 

 

19,013

 

 

25,642

 

 

 







Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts

 

 

1,314,234

 

 

1,195,415

 

 

 







 

 

$

1,346,283

 

$

1,229,304

 

 

 







At December 31, 2010, the bank had qualified loans, at carrying value of approximately $367.8 million, available to secure borrowings from the FHLB and the FRB of which $65.7 million were pledged to secure FHLB borrowings at December 31, 2010. There were no loans pledged at December 31, 2009.

Loan Origination/Risk Management

The Company has lending policies and procedures in place that are designed to maximize loan income within an acceptable level of risk. Management reviews and approves these policies and procedures on a regular basis. A reporting system supplements the review process by providing management with frequent reports related to loan production, loan quality, concentrations of credit, loan delinquencies and non-performing and potential problem loans. Diversification in the loan portfolio is a means of managing risk associated with fluctuations in economic conditions.

PAGE 77


Commercial and Loans to Nondepository Institutions

Sterling provides a full range of loans to small and medium-sized businesses with the objective of establishing longer term relationships. Loans generally range in size up to $20 million, tailored to meet customers’ long- and short-term needs, and include secured and unsecured lines of credit and business installment loans.

Loans generally are collateralized by accounts receivable, inventory and other assets. Sterling also provides back-office services, i.e., processing payroll, generating customer invoices, credit collection assistance and related payroll services.

Factoring

Factoring provides a complete finance package that combines working capital financing, credit risk protection, and accounts receivable management for companies in a variety of industries.

Clients can draw an advance as accounts receivables are sold/assigned to Sterling. By purchasing a client’s accounts receivable, Sterling records the receivable as an asset, and records a liability for the funds due to the client. Sterling also, on request, advances funds to its client prior to the collection of receivables, charging interest on such advances and satisfying such advances by the collection of receivables.

Commercial Real Estate

Sterling offers a range of commercial real estate lending including financing on commercial buildings, retail properties and mixed use properties. Loans are predicated on cash flow of the property and the value of the property determined by an independent appraisal.

Loans are made at fixed or floating rates. Fixed rate loans are tied to Treasury or FHLB benchmarks and other indices. Floating rate loans are based on the prime rate or other index.

Equipment Financing

Sterling engages in direct lending and indirect lending. Direct lending is when requests for financing originate with an end user seeking to finance equipment up to 60 months. Indirect lending arises through relationships with equipment financing brokers.

In both cases, underwriting is initiated with full evaluations made based upon the applicant’s historical performance, cash flow projections and value of equipment.

Residential Mortgage

Residential mortgage loans, principally on single-family residences, are made primarily for re-sale into the secondary market. Offering both fixed and adjustable rate residential mortgage loan products, mortgages are focused on conforming credit, government insured FHA and other high quality loan products. Jumbo loans are also originated for sale into the secondary market, or brokered to third party providers.

The Company maintains an independent loan review process that reviews and validates the credit risk program on a periodic basis. Results of these reviews are presented to management. The loan review process complements and reinforces the risk identification and assessment decisions made by lenders.

Concentrations of Credit

There are no industry concentrations (exceeding 10% of loans, gross) of loans held in portfolio. Approximately 69% of loans are to borrowers located in the New York metropolitan area. A further deterioration in economic conditions within the region including a decline in real estate values, higher unemployment and other factors which could adversely impact small and mid-sized businesses, could have a significant adverse impact on the quality of the Company’s loan portfolio. In addition, a decline in real estate values and higher unemployment within the mid-Atlantic region and North Carolina could adversely impact the Company’s residential real estate loan portfolio.

Approximately 20.7% or $26.8 million and 22.4% or $29.2 million of the Company’s net interest income and noninterest income are related to real estate lending in 2010 and 2009, respectively. Real estate prices in the U.S. market decreased significantly during 2009 and have continued to decrease in 2010. Continuing declines in real estate values could necessitate charge-offs in our mortgage loan portfolio that may impact our operating results. In addition, a sustained period of declining real estate values combined with the continued turbulence in the financial and credit markets would continue to limit our mortgage related revenues.

As of December 31, 2010, approximately 67.0% of the Company’s loan portfolio consisted of commercial and industrial, factored receivables, construction and commercial real estate loans. Because the Company’s loan portfolio contains a number of commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of one or a few of these loans could cause a significant increase in non-performing loans.

Related Party Loans

Loans are made to officers or directors (including their immediate families) of the Company or for the benefit of corporations in which they have a beneficial interest subject to applicable regulations. There were no outstanding balances on such loans in excess of $60 thousand to any individual or entity at December 31, 2010 or 2009.

PAGE 78


Nonperforming Loans

Nonaccrual loans are those on which the accrual of interest has ceased. Loans, including loans that are individually identified as being impaired under FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, are generally placed on nonaccrual status immediately if, in the opinion of management, principal or interest is not likely to be paid in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, or when principal or interest is past due 90 days or more and collateral, if any, is insufficient to cover principal and interest. Interest accrued but not collected at the date a loan is placed on nonaccrual status is reversed against interest income. Interest income is recognized on nonaccrual loans only to the extent received in cash. Where there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectibility of the loan principal, cash receipts, whether designated as principal or interest, are thereafter applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan. Loans are restored to accrual status when interest and principal payments are brought current and future payments are reasonable assured.

Nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2010 and 2009 totaled $6.6 million and $18.0 million, respectively. The interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans outstanding at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, in accordance with their original terms, is estimated to be $902 thousand, $1.5 million and $731 thousand, respectively, for the years then ended. Applicable interest income actually realized was $204 thousand, $743 thousand and $321 thousand, respectively, for the aforementioned years, and there were no commitments to lend additional funds on nonaccrual loans.

The following table sets forth the amount of nonaccrual loans of the Company at the end of each of the two most recent fiscal years.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







Nonaccrual loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

1,014

 

$

4,231

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

892

 

 

11,960

 

Factored receivables

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

1,614

 

 

1,786

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

3,124

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 







Total nonaccrual loans

 

$

6,644

 

$

17,977

 

 

 







The following table provides information regarding the past due status of loans at December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

30–59
Days
Past
Due

 

60–89
Days
Past
Due

 

90 &
Over
Past
Due

 

Total
Past
Due

 

Current

 

Total
Loans

 

MEMO
90 & Over
and Still
Accruing

 

















Commercial and industrial

 

$

16,899

 

$

4,693

 

$

1,015

 

$

22,607

 

$

595,616

 

$

618,223

 

 

$

1

 

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

1,399

 

 

579

 

 

958

 

 

2,936

 

 

141,299

 

 

144,235

 

 

 

66

 

 

Factored receivables

 

 

3,321

 

 

662

 

 

247

 

 

4,230

 

 

157,559

 

 

161,789

 

 

 

247

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage—portfolio

 

 

3,297

 

 

2,515

 

 

1,614

 

 

7,426

 

 

152,318

 

 

159,744

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

9,626

 

 

 

 

3,124

 

 

12,750

 

 

84,241

 

 

96,991

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,624

 

 

25,624

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

52

 

 

 

 

 

 

52

 

 

11,318

 

 

11,370

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,425

 

 

15,425

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

112,882

 

 

112,882

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
























Total loans, net of unearned discount

 

$

34,594

 

$

8,449

 

$

6,958

 

$

50,001

 

$

1,296,282

 

$

1,346,283

 

 

$

314

 

 

 

 
























At December 31, 2009, loans 90 days past due and still accruing included $849 thousand of commercial and industrial loans and $345 thousand equipment financing receivables.

Impaired Loans

Management considers a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, it is determined that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. Determination of impairment is treated the same across all classes of loans on a loan-by-loan basis. When management identifies a loan as

PAGE 79


impaired, the impairment is measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, except when the sole remaining source of repayment of the loan is the operation or liquidation of the collateral. In these cases management uses the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs when foreclosure is probable, instead of discounted cash flows. If management determines that the value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan (net of previous charge-offs, deferred loan fees or costs and unamortized premium or discount), impairment is recognized through an allowance estimate or a charge-off to the allowance.

When the ultimate collectibility of the total principal of an impaired loan is in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, all payments are applied to principal, under the cost recovery method. When the ultimate collectibility of the total principal of an impaired loan is not in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, contractual interest is credited to interest income when received, under the cash basis method. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

The following tables include the recorded investment and unpaid principal balances for impaired financing receivables with the associated allowance amount, if applicable. Management determined the specific allowance based on the present value of the expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, except when the remaining source of repayment for the loan is the operation or liquidation of the collateral. In those cases, the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs was used to determine the specific allowance recorded.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

Recorded
Investment
in Impaired
Loans

 

Principal
Balance
With No
Allowance

 

Principal
Balance
With
Allowance

 

Related
Allowance

 

Average
Recorded
Investment
in Impaired
Loans

 













Commercial and industrial

 

$

2,236

 

$

584

 

$

4,243

 

$

605

 

$

1,598

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

414

 

 

 

 

414

 

 

33

 

 

1,095

 

Factored receivables

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

4,904

 

 

 

 

4,990

 

 

1,104

 

 

3,681

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

3,124

 

 

 

 

3,124

 

 

1,100

 

 

1,725

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
















Total

 

$

10,678

 

$

584

 

$

12,771

 

$

2,842

 

$

8,099

 

 

 
















 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


















Commercial and industrial

 

$

1,666

 

$

2,720

 

$

577

 

$

129

 

$

527

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

619

 

 

 

 

619

 

 

61

 

 

3,339

 

Factored receivables

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

3,249

 

 

 

 

3,304

 

 

489

 

 

1,289

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
















Total

 

$

5,534

 

$

2,720

 

$

4,500

 

$

679

 

$

5,155

 

 

 
















The average recorded investment in accruing impaired restructured loans was approximately $4.5 million, $3.2 million and $4.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. The recognition of interest income on these accruing impaired loans is based upon an individual assessment of each loan; however, interest income is not accrued on a loan that is more than 90 days past due. Interest income recognized on these loans during impairment was approximately $60 thousand, $270 thousand and $90 thousand for 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

PAGE 80


As of December 31, 2008, $4.2 million of loans were judged to be impaired within the scope of FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, with interest income recognized on a cash basis. The average recorded investment in impaired loans during the year ended December 31, 2008 was approximately $4.3 million. The application of FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables indicated that these loans required valuation allowances totaling $285 thousand at December 31, 2008, which are included within the overall allowance for loan losses. The interest income that would have been earned on impaired loans outstanding at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 in accordance with their original terms is estimated to be $202 thousand, $323 thousand and $23 thousand, respectively, for the years then ended. Applicable interest income actually realized on a cash basis was $184 thousand, $270 thousand and $-0-, respectively, for the aforementioned years, and there were no commitments to lend additional funds on impaired loans.

Credit Quality Indicators

As part of the ongoing monitoring of the credit quality of the Company’s loan portfolio, management tracks certain credit quality indicators including trends related to (i) the risk grade of loans, (ii) the level of classified loans, (iii) charge-offs, (iv) nonperforming loans and (v) the general economic conditions in the New York metropolitan area.

The Company categorizes loans into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt, such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic trends, among other factors. The Company has a process for analyzing non-homogeneous loans, such as commercial and commercial real estate loans, individually by grading the loans based on credit risk. This analysis occurs at varying times based on the type of loan as well as the loan balance and occurs at least once every 18 months for those loans greater than $500,000.

For homogeneous loan pools, such as residential mortgages, leases, consumer loans, the Company uses payment status to identify the credit risk in these loan portfolios. Payment status is reviewed on a daily basis by the Company’s personnel and on a monthly basis with respect to determining the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. The payment status of these homogeneous pools at December 31, 2010 is included in the aging of the recorded investment of past due loans table above. In addition, the total nonperforming portion of these homogeneous loan pools at December 31, 2010 is presented in the recorded investment in nonaccrual loans table above.

The Company utilizes a risk grading matrix to assign a risk grade to each of its commercial loans. Loans under $100,000 are not risk rated. Loans are graded on a scale of 1 to 9. A description of the general characteristics of the 9 risk grades is as follows:

Risk Rating 1 & 2/High Quality/Minimal Risk—These loans are well secured by liquid or high quality, diversified, and readily marketable securities within the bank’s defined margin requirements including cash surrender value of life insurance, or loans to strong privately held obligors secured by real estate with satisfactory loan to value, and support guarantors. They could include loans to publicly traded entities with strong credit ratings (A-1 or better) with Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s.

Risk Rating 3 & 4/Very Good/Good Quality—These loans can be either unsecured or secured (with monthly monitoring of Accounts Receivable and/or Inventory) to adequately or moderately capitalized privately held obligors with satisfactory sales, revenue, earnings trends, cash flow, and leverage. These secured loans may be monitored in the Asset Based Lending or the Factoring Department to include control of cash receipts and defined formula advances. These categories could include loans to publicly traded entities with credit ratings of A-3 or lower by Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s.

Risk Rating 5/Watch List—These loans are to companies with uneven financial performance containing exceptions to loan policy without mitigating factors. These loans may exist when the obligors experience temporary credit and/or structural deficiencies. Such credits have not been criticized by Loan Review. Close supervision is warranted to avoid further deterioration.

Risk Rating 6/Special mention (OCC Definition)—Other Assets Especially Mentioned (OAEM) are loans that are currently protected but are potentially weak. Special Mention ratings have potential weaknesses which may, if not checked or corrected, weaken the asset or inadequately protect the bank’s credit position at some future date. Such assets constitute an undue and unwarranted credit risk but not to the point of justifying a classification of substandard. The credit risk may be relatively minor yet constitute an unwarranted risk in light of the circumstances surrounding a specific asset.

Risk Rating 7/Substandard (OCC Definition)—These loans are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Assets so classified must have a well-defined weakness that jeopardizes the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loss potential, while existing in the aggregate amount of substandard assets, does not have to exist in individual assets classified as substandard.

• Risk Rating 8/doubtful (OCC Definition)—These loans have all the weakness inherent in one classified as substandard with the added characteristics that the weakness makes collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable.

PAGE 81


The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of certain important and reasonably specific pending factors which may work to the advantage and strengthening of the asset, its classification as an estimated loss is deferred until its more exact status may be determined. Pending factors include proposed merger, acquisition, or liquidating procedures, capital injection, perfecting liens or additional collateral and refinancing plans.

Risk Rating 9/Loss (OCC Definition)—These loans are classified as Loss and charged off because they are determined to be uncollectible and unbankable assets. This classification does not mean that the asset has absolutely no recovery or salvage value, but rather it is not practical or desirable to defer writing off this basically worthless asset even though partial recovery may be effected in the future. The bank should not be allowed to attempt long-term recoveries while the asset remains booked. Losses should be taken in the period in which they are determined to be uncollectible.

The following table presents weighted average risk grades and classified loans by class of commercial loan. Classified loans include loans in Risk Grades 6, 7 and 8.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

Weighted
Average
Risk Grade

 

Classified
Loans

 









Commercial and industrial

 

 

3.32

 

$

3,450

 

Factored receivables

 

 

2.76

 

 

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

3.36

 

 

3,124

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

4.55

 

 

5,249

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

3.00

 

 

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

3.06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

Total

 

 

3.24

 

$

11,823

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance reflects management’s best estimate of probable losses within the existing loan portfolio and of the risk inherent in various components of the loan portfolio. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risk inherent in the loan portfolio. Additions to the allowance for loan losses are made by charges to the provision for loan losses. Credit exposures deemed to be uncollectible are charged against the allowance for loan losses. Recoveries of previously charged off amounts are credited to the allowance for loan losses.

The Company’s allowance for loan loss methodology is based on guidance provided by the “Interagency Policy Statement on the Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses” issued by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve system, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the National Credit Union Administration and the Office of Thrift Supervision in December 2006 and includes an allowance allocation calculated in accordance with U.S. GAAP guidance in FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies. Accordingly, the methodology is based on historical loss experience by type of credit and internal risk grade, specific homogeneous risk pools and specific loss allocations, with adjustments for current events and conditions.

The level of the allowance for loan losses relies on a consistent process that requires multiple layers of management review and judgment and of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio quality, present economic, political and regulatory conditions and unidentified losses inherent in the current loan portfolio. Portions of the allowance may be allocated to specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including, among other things, the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.

PAGE 82


The Company’s allowance for loan losses includes (1) specific valuation allowances for impaired loans evaluated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables; (2) formulaic allowances based on historical loss experience by loan category, adjusted, as necessary, to reflect the impact of current conditions; and (3) unallocated general valuation allowances determined in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies based on general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to the Company.

The allowance established for losses on specific loans is based on a regular analysis and evaluation of problem loans. Loans are classified based on an internal credit risk grading process that evaluates, among other things: (i) the obligor’s ability to repay; (ii) the underlying collateral, if any; and (iii) the economic environment and industry in which the borrower operates. This analysis is performed at the relationship manager level for all loans. When a loan has a calculated grade of 6 or higher, an analysis is performed to determine whether the loan is impaired and, if impaired, the need to specifically allocate a portion of the allowance for loan losses to the loan. Specific valuation allowances are determined by analyzing the borrower’s ability to repay amounts owed, collateral deficiencies, the relative risk grade of the loan and economic conditions affecting the borrower’s industry, among other things.

Historical valuation allowances are calculated based on the historical loss experience of specific types of loans and the internal risk grade of such loans at the time they were charged-off. The Company calculates historical loss ratios for pools of similar loans with similar characteristics based on the portion of actual charge-offs experienced to the total population of loans in the pool. The historical loss ratios are periodically updated based on actual charge-off experience. A historical valuation allowance is established for each pool of similar loans based upon the product of the historical loss ratio and the total dollar amount of the loans in the pool. During 2010 the Company revised its historical loss ratio calculation to reflect a five year history from a ten year history to reflect the current loss experience. The Company’s pool of similar loans include similarly risk-graded groups of commercial and industrial loans, commercial real estate loans, residential real estate loans and consumer and other loans.

General valuation allowances are based on general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to the Company. In general, such valuation allowances are determined by evaluating, among other things:

 

 

Estimated future losses in all significant loans

 

 

Existence and effect of any concentrations of credit

 

 

Existence and effect of any geographic concentration

 

 

Other external factors such as competition, legal matters or regulation that may affect risk

 

 

Effect of criticized and classified loans

 

 

Effects from risk arising with international lending

 

 

Effectiveness of internal problem loan identification and risk ratings

 

 

Trends in portfolio volume, maturity and compositions of loans within segments

 

 

Volumes and trends in delinquencies and nonaccrual loans

 

 

Changes in the quality of lending policies and procedures

 

 

Changes in local and national economic conditions

 

 

Experience, ability and depth of lending staff

 

 

Changes in value of underlying collateral

Management evaluates the degree of risk that each one of these components has on the quality of the loan portfolio on a quarterly basis. Each component is determined based on degree of risk. The results are then input into a “general allocation matrix” to determine an appropriate general valuation allowance.

Included in the general valuation allowances are allocations for groups of similar loans with risk characteristics that exceed certain concentration limits established by management. Concentration risk limits have been established, among other things, for certain industry concentrations, large and highly leveraged credit relationships that exceed specified risk grades, and loans originated with policy exceptions that exceed specified risk grades.

Loans are generally charged-off at the earlier of when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive or when they have been identified as losses by management, internal loan review and/or bank examiners. Furthermore, equipment financing receivable and revolving credit lines to small businesses are charged-off at the earlier of when payments are 120 days past due or when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive. Factors considered in determining whether collection efforts are no longer productive include any amounts currently being collected, the status of discussions or negotiations with the lessee/borrower, the principal and/or guarantors, the cost of continuing efforts to collect, the status of any foreclosure or other legal actions, the value of the collateral, and any other pertinent factors.

PAGE 83


The following table presents the activity in the allowance for the periods shown:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 












 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

19,872

 

$

16,010

 

$

15,085

 

 

 









 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charge-offs:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

 

7,212

 

 

4,945

 

 

2,610

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

22,509

 

 

19,115

 

 

3,886

 

Factored receivables

 

 

665

 

 

514

 

 

581

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

351

 

 

312

 

 

58

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

129

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

231

 

 

 

 

 

 

 









 

Total charge-offs

 

 

31,097

 

 

24,886

 

 

7,135

 

 

 









 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Recoveries:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

 

312

 

 

1,042

 

 

297

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

902

 

 

345

 

 

294

 

Factored receivables

 

 

239

 

 

63

 

 

26

 

Real estate—residential mortgage

 

 

 

 

102

 

 

61

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

48

 

 

 

 

69

 

 

 









 

Total recoveries

 

 

1,501

 

 

1,552

 

 

747

 

 

 









 

Subtract:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

 

 

29,596

 

 

23,334

 

 

6,388

 

 

 









 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

28,500

 

 

27,900

 

 

8,325

 

 

 









 

Less loss on transfers to other real estate owned

 

 

538

 

 

704

 

 

1,012

 

 

 









 

Balance at end of year

 

$

18,238

 

$

19,872

 

$

16,010

 

 

 









 

The following table presents the balance in the allowance for loan losses and the recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment and based on impairment method as of December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending Allowance Balance

 

Loan Balances

 

 

 









 










 

 

Attributable to Loans
Evaluated for Impairment

 

 

 

 

Evaluated for Impairment

 

 

 

 

 

 


 

 

 

 


 

 

 

 

 

 

Individually

 

Collectively

 

Total

 

Individually

 

Collectively

 

Total

 

 

 



 



 



 



 



 



 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

605

 

$

6,849

 

$

7,454

 

$

2,236

 

$

615,987

 

$

618,223

 

Equipment financing receivables

 

 

33

 

 

3,390

 

 

3,423

 

 

414

 

 

143,821

 

 

144,235

 

Factored receivables

 

 

 

 

1,424

 

 

1,424

 

 

 

 

161,789

 

 

161,789

 

Real estate—residential mortgage (portfolio)

 

 

1,104

 

 

1,393

 

 

2,497

 

 

4,904

 

 

122,791

 

 

127,695

 

Real estate—commercial mortgage

 

 

1,100

 

 

1,175

 

 

2,275

 

 

3,124

 

 

93,867

 

 

96,991

 

Real estate—construction and land development

 

 

 

 

310

 

 

310

 

 

 

 

25,624

 

 

25,624

 

Loans to individuals

 

 

 

 

119

 

 

119

 

 

 

 

11,370

 

 

11,370

 

Loans to depository institutions

 

 

 

 

46

 

 

46

 

 

 

 

15,425

 

 

15,425

 

Loans to nondepository institutions

 

 

 

 

564

 

 

564

 

 

 

 

112,882

 

 

112,882

 

Unallocated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

126

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


















 

Total

 

$

2,842

 

$

15,270

 

$

18,238

 

$

10,678

 

$

1,303,556

 

$

1,314,234

 

 

 


















 

PAGE 84


NOTE 7.

FEDERAL RESERVE AND FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK STOCK

The bank is required to maintain a minimum level of investment in Federal Home Loan Bank of New York stock (“FHLB”) based on specific percentages of its outstanding mortgages, total assets or FHLB advances. FHLB and Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) stocks are restricted because they may only be sold to another member institution or the FHLB or FRB at their par values. Due to restrictive terms, and the lack of a readily determinable market value, FHLB and FRB stocks are carried at cost.

NOTE 8.

PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

The following table presents information on premises and equipment:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 








 

Land and building

 

$

344

 

$

322

 

Furniture and equipment

 

 

14,526

 

 

13,701

 

Leasehold improvements

 

 

16,085

 

 

11,399

 

 

 






 

 

 

 

30,955

 

 

25,422

 

Accumulated amortization and depreciation

 

 

15,046

 

 

15,764

 

 

 






 

Premises and equipment, net

 

$

15,909

 

$

9,658

 

 

 






 

NOTE 9.

INTEREST-BEARING DEPOSITS

The following table presents certain information for interest expense on deposits:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 











 

Interest expense

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits in domestic offices

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Savings

 

$

11

 

$

18

 

$

59

 

NOW

 

 

472

 

 

620

 

 

2,306

 

Money Market

 

 

2,805

 

 

3,252

 

 

4,038

 

Time

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Three months or less

 

 

2,665

 

 

3,493

 

 

3,674

 

More than three months through twelve months

 

 

3,086

 

 

3,807

 

 

10,203

 

More than twelve months through twenty-four months

 

 

270

 

 

295

 

 

793

 

More than twenty-four months through thirty-six months

 

 

212

 

 

345

 

 

376

 

More than thirty-six months through forty-eight months

 

 

23

 

 

8

 

 

39

 

More than forty-eight months through sixty months

 

 

41

 

 

45

 

 

14

 

More than sixty months

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 









 

 

 

 

9,585

 

 

11,883

 

 

21,502

 

Interest-bearing deposits in foreign offices

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Time

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Three months or less

 

 

3

 

 

4

 

 

4

 

More than three months through twelve months

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

2

 

 

 









 

Total

 

$

9,588

 

$

11,889

 

$

21,508

 

 

 









 

The aggregate of time certificates of deposit and other time deposits in denominations of $100 thousand or more was $488.4 million and $301.6 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

PAGE 85


The following table provides certain information with respect to the Company’s deposits at the end of the two most recent fiscal years:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







Domestic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Demand

 

$

570,290

 

$

546,337

 

NOW

 

 

200,521

 

 

266,343

 

Savings

 

 

18,931

 

 

17,497

 

Money Market

 

 

342,755

 

 

308,175

 

Time deposits by remaining maturity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Three months or less

 

 

176,070

 

 

195,233

 

More than three months through six months

 

 

228,635

 

 

78,959

 

More than six months through twelve months

 

 

158,559

 

 

115,432

 

More than twelve months through twenty-four months

 

 

32,645

 

 

24,105

 

More than twenty-four months through thirty-six months

 

 

13,624

 

 

22,312

 

More than thirty-six months through forty-eight months

 

 

5,177

 

 

282

 

More than forty-eight months through sixty months

 

 

466

 

 

5,412

 

More than sixty months

 

 

91

 

 

 

 

 






 

Total domestic

 

 

1,747,764

 

 

1,580,087

 

 

 






 

Foreign

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Three months or less

 

 

 

 

395

 

More than three months through six months

 

 

 

 

185

 

 

 






 

Total foreign

 

 

 

 

580

 

 

 






 

Total

 

$

1,747,764

 

$

1,580,667

 

 

 






 

The Company began participating in the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”) on January 22, 2009. CDARS deposits totaled approximately $180.7 million and $82.3 million at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009, respectively.

PAGE 86


NOTE 10.

SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS

The following table presents information regarding short-term borrowings:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Federal funds purchased

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

15,000

 

$

41,000

 

$

131,000

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

0.15

%

 

0.16

%

 

0.30

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

1 Day

 

 

1 Day

 

 

1 Day

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

105,000

 

 

87,000

 

 

131,000

 

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

33,192

 

 

25,075

 

 

50,368

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.22

%

 

0.21

%

 

1.79

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

0.10–0.35

%

 

0.06–0.50

%

 

0.19–4.56

%

 

 

 










Commercial paper

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

14,388

 

$

17,297

 

$

11,732

 

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

0.29

%

 

0.31

%

 

0.94

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

45 Days

 

 

34 Days

 

 

35 Days

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

16,927

 

 

17,297

 

 

24,650

 

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

14,718

 

 

13,107

 

 

17,806

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.30

%

 

0.51

%

 

2.59

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

0.20–0.65

%

 

0.15–2.25

%

 

0.75–4.95

%

 

 

 










Short-term borrowings—FHLB

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

 

$

 

$

75,000

 

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.46

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

 

 

 

 

1 Day

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

 

 

 

 

120,000

 

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

 

 

3,411

 

 

69,708

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

 

 

0.31

%

 

1.88

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

 

 

0.45–0.63

%

 

0.38–4.44

%

 

 

 










Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

 

$

50,000

 

$

100,000

 

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

 

 

0.25

%

 

0.35

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

 

 

70 Days

 

 

56 Days

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

25,000

 

 

235,000

 

 

100,000

 

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

3,699

 

 

154,726

 

 

8,841

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.25

%

 

0.26

%

 

0.53

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

0.25

%

 

0.25–0.50

%

 

0.28–2.50

%

 

 

 










Short-term borrowings—treasury tax and loan and term Federal funds purchased

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

3,490

 

$

2,509

 

$

1,338

 

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.11

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

1 Day

 

 

1 Day

 

 

3 Days

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

46,779

 

 

4,262

 

 

5,250

 

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

7,306

 

 

1,864

 

 

1,707

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.25

%

 

 

 

2.04

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

-0- –0.40

%

 

 

 

0.16–3.94

%

 

 

 










The parent company has agreements with banks for back-up lines of credit for which it pays a fee at the annual rate of ¼ of 1% times the line of credit extended. At December 31, 2010, these back-up bank lines of credit totaled $19 million; no lines were used at any time during 2010, 2009 or 2008.

PAGE 87


NOTE 11.

SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are secured by obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises and corporate debt obligations with a carrying amount of $31.6 million and $24.8 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are financing arrangements that mature within two years. At maturity, the securities underlying the agreements are returned to the Company. Information concerning securities sold under agreements to repurchase is summarized as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 










Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

23,016

 

$

21,048

 

$

44,334

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

0.45

%

 

0.46

%

 

1.09

%

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

35 Days

 

 

36 Days

 

 

32 Days

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

55,998

 

 

80,960

 

 

99,103

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

47,674

 

 

72,892

 

 

89,602

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.48

%

 

0.48

%

 

2.07

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

0.35–0.65

%

 

0.25–2.00

%

 

0.75–4.60

%

 

 

 










Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At December 31 —Balance

 

$

5,000

 

$

 

$

 

 

—Average interest rate

 

 

1.30

%

 

 

 

 

 

—Average original maturity

 

 

731 Days

 

 

 

 

 

During the year —Maximum month-end balance

 

 

39,893

 

 

 

 

72,923

 

 

—Daily average balance

 

 

5,618

 

 

 

 

41,808

 

 

—Average interest rate paid

 

 

0.79

%

 

 

 

2.69

%

 

—Range of interest rates paid

 

 

0.25–1.30

%

 

 

 

2.10–5.02

%

 

 

 









 

NOTE 12.

ADVANCES—FHLB AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS

These borrowings represent advances from the FHLB and junior subordinated debt securities issued by the parent company.

The following table presents information regarding fixed rate FHLB advances:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

Advance
Type

 

 

Interest
Rate

 

Maturity
Date

 

Initial
Call Date

 


 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 


















Callable

 

 

4.70

%

 

2/22/11

 

 

2/20/03

 

$

10,000

 

$

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

3.19

 

 

1/16/13

 

 

1/16/09

 

 

20,000

 

 

20,000

 

Callable

 

 

1.96

 

 

2/28/13

 

 

3/2/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

1.834

 

 

3/19/13

 

 

3/19/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.318

 

 

3/19/13

 

 

3/19/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.155

 

 

3/29/10

 

 

3/27/09

 

 

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.53

 

 

5/6/13

 

 

2/6/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.57

 

 

7/2/18

 

 

1/2/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.505

 

 

8/8/18

 

 

2/9/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.94

 

 

9/5/13

 

 

3/5/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Callable

 

 

2.783

 

 

9/12/13

 

 

3/12/09

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Term

 

 

2.26

 

 

7/16/12

 

 

 

 

10,000

 

 

10,000

 

Term

 

 

1.73

 

 

4/12/13

 

 

 

 

2,024

 

 

 

Term

 

 

2.13

 

 

4/14/14

 

 

 

 

2,149

 

 

 

Term

 

 

0.70

 

 

8/4/11

 

 

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

Term

 

 

0.55

 

 

3/23/11

 

 

 

 

5,000

 

 

 

Term

 

 

0.61

 

 

9/23/11

 

 

 

 

5,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 







Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

144,173

 

$

130,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 







Weighted-average interest rate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2.42

%

 

2.69

%

Under the terms of a collateral agreement with the FHLB, advances are secured by stock in the FHLB and by certain qualifying assets (primarily mortgage-backed securities) having market values at least equal to 110% of the advances outstanding. After the initial call date, each callable advance is callable by the FHLB quarterly from the initial call date, at par.

PAGE 88


In February 2002, the parent company completed its issuance of trust capital securities (“capital securities”) that raised $25 million ($24.1 million net proceeds after issuance costs). The 8.375% capital securities, due March 31, 2032, were issued by Sterling Bancorp Trust I (the “trust”), a wholly-owned non-consolidated statutory business trust. The trust was formed with initial capitalization of common stock and for the exclusive purpose of issuing the capital securities. The trust used the proceeds from the issuance of the capital securities to acquire $25.8 million junior subordinated debt securities that pay interest at 8.375% (“debt securities”) issued by the parent company. The Company is not considered the primary beneficiary of the trust (which is a VIE), therefore the trust is not consolidated in the Company’s financial statements, but rather the subordinated debentures are shown as a liability. The debt securities are due concurrently with the capital securities which may not be redeemed, except under limited circumstances, until March 31, 2007, and thereafter at a price equal to their principal amount plus interest accrued to the date of redemption. The Company may also reduce outstanding capital securities through open market purchases. During 2010 and 2009, the parent company did not purchase any capital securities; during 2008, the parent company purchased in the open market $817 thousand par amount of the capital securities at an aggregate cost of $786 thousand. These securities are included in the Company’s securities available for sale. These securities are considered to be outstanding for the payment of dividends but are considered to be redeemed for the calculation of the regulatory capital ratios. During 2010, the Company’s tax-qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “Plan”) did not purchase any capital securities. During 2009, the Plan purchased in the open market $652 thousand par amount of the capital securities at an aggregate cost of $495 thousand. As a result of these repurchases, the amounts of capital securities held by third parties at December 31, 2010 and 2009 were $22.8 million and $22.8 million, respectively. Dividends and interest are paid quarterly.

The parent company has the right to defer payments of interest on the debt securities at any time or from time to time for a period of up to 20 consecutive quarterly periods with respect to each deferral period. Under the terms of the debt securities, in the event that under certain circumstances there is an event of default under the debt securities or the parent company has elected to defer interest on the debt securities, the parent company may not, with certain exceptions, declare or pay any dividends or distributions on its capital stock or purchase or acquire any of its capital stock.

Payments of distributions on the capital securities and payments on redemption of the capital securities are guaranteed by the parent company on a limited basis. The parent company also entered into an agreement as to expenses and liabilities pursuant to which it agreed, on a subordinated basis, to pay any costs, expenses or liabilities of the trust other than those arising under the capital securities. The obligations of the parent company under the debt securities, the related indenture, the trust agreement establishing the trust, the guarantee and the agreement as to expenses and liabilities, in the aggregate, constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the parent company of the trust’s obligations under the capital securities.

Notwithstanding that the accounts of the trust are not included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements, the amount of capital securities issued by the trust and held by third parties is included in the Tier 1 capital of the parent company for regulatory capital purposes as allowed by the Federal Reserve Board. In March 2005, the Federal Reserve Board adopted a rule that would continue to allow the inclusion of capital securities issued by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts in Tier 1 capital, but with stricter quantitative limits. Under the final rule, after March 31, 2011, the aggregate amount of capital securities and certain other capital elements would be limited to 25% of Tier 1 capital, net of goodwill less any associated deferred tax liability. Based on the final rule, the parent company currently expects to continue to include the amount of capital securities held by third parties in Tier 1 capital.

NOTE 13.

DUE TO FACTORED CLIENTS

Due to factored clients represents amounts due on accounts receivable purchased in excess of the amounts advanced.

PAGE 89


NOTE 14.

PREFERRED STOCK

The parent company is authorized to issue up to 644,389 shares of preferred stock, $5 par value, in one or more series. The following table presents information regarding the parent company’s preferred stock issued and outstanding:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 


Series A shares. Issued and outstanding—42,000 shares, at liquidation value

 

$

42,000

 

$

42,000

 

Under the provisions of the TARP Capital Purchase Program enacted under EESA, on December 23, 2008, the parent company sold to the U.S. Treasury 42,000 shares of the parent company’s fixed rate cumulative perpetual preferred stock, Series A, par value $5.00 per share, having a liquidation preference of $1 thousand per share (the “Series A Preferred Shares”), together with a warrant to purchase 516,817 shares of its common shares, for an aggregate price of $42 million.

Under the standardized terms of the TARP Capital Purchase Program, cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares will accrue on the liquidation preference at a rate of 5% per annum for the first five years, and at a rate of 9% per annum thereafter, but will be paid only if, as and when declared by the parent company’s Board of Directors. The Series A Preferred Shares have no maturity date and rank senior to the parent company’s common shares with respect to the payment of dividends and distributions and amounts payable upon liquidation, dissolution and winding up of the parent company. The preferred shares currently qualify as Tier 1 capital for regulatory capital purposes.

As long as the Series A Preferred Shares remain outstanding, the parent company may declare and pay dividends on its common shares only if all accrued and unpaid dividends for all past dividend periods on the Series A Preferred Shares are fully paid. Prior to December 23, 2011, unless we have redeemed all such preferred shares or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all such preferred shares to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to, among other things, increase the dividend on our common shares above the quarterly cash dividend of $0.19 per share. The terms of the parent company’s agreement with the U.S. Treasury allow for additional restrictions, including those on dividends, to be imposed by the U.S. Treasury, including unilateral amendments to comply with legislative changes.

The consent of the U.S. Treasury generally is also required for the parent company to make any stock repurchase (other than in connection with the administration of any employee benefit plan in the ordinary course of business and consistent with past practice) until December 23, 2011, unless all of the Series A Preferred Shares have been redeemed or transferred by the U.S. Treasury to unaffiliated third parties. Further, common shares, junior preferred shares or pari passu preferred shares may not be repurchased if the parent company is in arrears on the payment of dividends on Series A Preferred Shares.

The warrant has a 10-year term with 50% vesting immediately upon issuance and the remaining 50% vesting on January 1, 2010 if certain qualified equity offerings have not been conducted. As the Company did not conduct any qualified equity offering after the issuance of the Series A Preferred Shares, 100% of the warrant has been vested. The warrant has an exercise price, subject to anti-dilution adjustments, equal to $12.19 per common share.

The parent company may redeem the Series A Preferred Shares three years after the date of the U.S. Treasury’s investment, or earlier if it raises in an equity offering net proceeds equal to the amount of the Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed. It must raise proceeds equal to at least 25% of the issue price of the Series A Preferred Shares to redeem any Series A Preferred Shares prior to the end of the third year. The redemption price is equal to the sum of the liquidation amount per share and any unpaid dividends on the Series A

PAGE 90


Preferred Shares up to, but excluding, the date fixed for redemption. Notwithstanding the foregoing limitations, under the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 the U.S. Treasury may, after consultation with the parent company’s federal regulator, permit the parent company at any time to redeem the Series A Preferred Shares at liquidation value. Upon such redemption, the common stock purchase warrant may also be repurchased at its then current fair value.

The Series A Preferred Shares and the warrant issued under the TARP program qualify and are accounted for as permanent equity on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet. Of the $42 million in total issuance proceeds, $39.4 million and $2.6 million were allocated to the Series A Preferred Shares and the warrant, respectively, based upon their estimated fair values as of December 23, 2008. The resulting discount of $2.6 million recorded for the Series A Preferred Shares is being accreted by a charge to retained earnings over a five-year estimated life of the preferred shares based on the likelihood of their redemption by the parent company within that timeframe. Accretion of discount amounted to $489 thousand in 2010, $673 thousand in 2009 and $55 thousand in 2008.

The proceeds from the issuance to the U.S. Treasury were allocated based on the relative fair value of the warrants as compared with the fair value of the preferred stock. The fair value of the warrants was determined using a valuation model which incorporates assumptions regarding our common stock price, dividend yield, expected life of the warrants, stock price volatility and the risk-free interest rate. The fair value of the preferred stock was determined based on assumptions regarding the discount rate (market rate) on the preferred stock, which was estimated to be approximately 13% at the date of issuance. The discount on the preferred stock will be accreted to liquidation value using a constant effective yield of 6.431% over a five-year term, which is the expected life of the preferred stock.

NOTE 15.

COMMON STOCK

The following table provides information regarding the number of common shares issued:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Number of
Shares Issued

 

 

 


Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 


Issued at beginning of year

 

 

22,226,425

 

 

22,202,419

 

Shares issued—public offering

 

 

8,625,000

 

 

 

Shares issued under stock incentive plan

 

 

287,120

 

 

24,006

 

 

 






 

Issued at end of year

 

 

31,138,545

 

 

22,226,425

 

 

 






 

NOTE 16.

TREASURY STOCK

The following table provides information regarding the number of shares held by the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Number of
Shares Held

 

 

 


Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 


Held at beginning of year

 

 

4,119,934

 

 

4,107,191

 

Surrender of shares issued under incentive compensation plan

 

 

177,848

 

 

12,743

 

 

 






 

Held at end of year

 

 

4,297,782

 

 

4,119,934

 

 

 






 

PAGE 91


NOTE 17.

ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

Information related to the components of accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income is as follows with related tax effect:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 


Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized holding gains on available for sale securities and other instruments, arising during the period:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before tax

 

$

3,846

 

$

5,564

 

$

664

 

Tax effect

 

 

(1,745

)

 

(2,525

)

 

(304

)

 

 









 

Net of tax

 

 

2,101

 

 

3,039

 

 

360

 

 

 









 

Reclassification adjustment for securities (gains) losses included in net income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before tax

 

 

(3,928

)

 

(5,561

)

 

1,684

 

Tax effect

 

 

1,783

 

 

2,524

 

 

(764

)

 

 









 

Net of tax

 

 

(2,145

)

 

(3,037

)

 

920

 

 

 









 

Pension liability adjustment—net actuarial (losses) gains:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before tax

 

 

(3,551

)

 

3,544

 

 

(13,938

)

Tax effect

 

 

1,611

 

 

(1,609

)

 

6,325

 

 

 









 

Net of tax

 

 

(1,940

)

 

1,935

 

 

(7,613

)

 

 









 

Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service cost:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before tax

 

 

67

 

 

67

 

 

67

 

Tax effect

 

 

(31

)

 

(31

)

 

(31

)

 

 









 

Net of tax

 

 

36

 

 

36

 

 

36

 

 

 









 

Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net actuarial losses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before tax

 

 

2,673

 

 

3,454

 

 

1,557

 

Tax effect

 

 

(1,213

)

 

(1,567

)

 

(707

)

 

 









 

Net of tax

 

 

1,460

 

 

1,887

 

 

850

 

 

 









 

Other comprehensive (loss) income

 

$

(488

)

$

3,860

 

$

(5,447

)

 

 









 

The following table presents the components of accumulated other comprehensive loss as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 included in shareholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax
Amount

 

Tax
Effect

 

After-tax
Amount

 


December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net unrealized gain on securities

 

$

343

 

$

(161

)

$

182

 

Adjustment for underfunded pension and postretirement life insurance obligations

 

 

(23,881

)

 

10,812

 

 

(13,069

)

 

 









 

Total

 

$

(23,538

)

$

10,651

 

$

(12,887

)

 

 









 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net unrealized gain on securities

 

$

425

 

$

(203

)

$

222

 

Adjustment for underfunded pension and postretirement life insurance obligations

 

 

(23,073

)

 

10,452

 

 

(12,621

)

 

 









 

Total

 

$

(22,648

)

$

10,249

 

$

(12,399

)

 

 









 

PAGE 92


NOTE 18.

RESTRICTIONS ON THE BANK

The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank. Approval by the Comptroller of the Currency is required if the effect of dividends declared would cause the regulatory capital of the bank to fall below specified minimum levels. Additionally, all national banks are limited in the payment of dividends in any year without the approval of the Comptroller of the Currency to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for that year to date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years. Under the foregoing restrictions, as of December 31, 2010 the bank could pay dividends of approximately $32.3 million to the parent company, without regulatory approval.

Federal law also prohibits national banks from paying dividends that would be greater than the bank’s undivided profits after deducting statutory bad debt in excess of the bank’s allowance for loan losses. Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), a depository institution, such as the bank, may not pay dividends if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or it is already undercapitalized. The payment of dividends by the parent company and the bank may also be affected or limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital.

NOTE 19.

STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN

In April 1992, shareholders approved a Stock Incentive Plan (“the plan”) covering up to 100,000 common shares of the parent company. Under the plan, key employees of the parent company and its subsidiaries could be granted awards in the form of incentive stock options (“ISOs”), non-qualified stock options (“NQSOs”), stock appreciation rights (“SARs”), restricted stock or, a combination of these. The plan is administered by a committee of the Board of Directors. Since the inception of the plan, shareholders have approved amendments increasing the number of shares covered under the plan; the total number of shares authorized by shareholders through December 31, 2010 was 2,650,000. The plan provides for proportional adjustment to the number of shares covered by the plan and by outstanding awards, and in the exercise price of outstanding stock options, to reflect, among other things, stock splits and stock dividends. After giving effect to stock option and restricted stock awards granted and the effect of the 5% stock dividend effected December 12, 2005, the six-for-five stock split in the form of a stock dividend effected in December 2004, the five-for-four stock split in the form of a stock dividend effected September 10, 2003, the 20% stock dividend paid in December 2002, the 10% stock dividends paid in December 2001 and December 2000, and the 5% stock dividend paid in December 1999, shares available for grant were 649,190, at December 31, 2010. The Company issues new shares to satisfy stock option exercises. The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $171 thousand, $61 thousand and $4.4 million, respectively.

PAGE 93


Stock Options

The following tables present information on the qualified and non-qualified stock options outstanding (after the effect of the stock dividends/splits discussed above) as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 and changes during the years then ended:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 







Qualified Stock Options

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 





















Outstanding at beginning of year

 

 

204,112

 

$

12.46

 

 

231,898

 

$

12.11

 

 

445,557

 

$

10.87

 

Exercised

 

 

(53,754

)

 

6.94

 

 

(24,006

)

 

8.69

 

 

(167,824

)

 

9.42

 

Reclassified[1]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(42,055

)

 

9.53

 

Forfeited

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3,780

)

 

14.60

 

 

(3,780

)

 

14.60

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

Outstanding at end of year

 

 

150,358

 

 

14.43

 

 

204,112

 

 

12.46

 

 

231,898

 

 

12.11

 

 

 



















Options exercisable at end of year

 

 

143,502

 

 

 

 

 

190,401

 

 

 

 

 

198,815

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 







Non-Qualified Stock Options

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 

Number of
Options

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise Price

 















Outstanding at beginning of year

 

 

460,102

 

$

15.49

 

 

533,338

 

$

16.34

 

 

1,319,133

 

$

12.85

 

Exercised

 

 

(149,638

)

 

6.94

 

 

 

 

 

 

(756,064

)

 

9.64

 

Reclassified[1]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

42,055

 

 

9.53

 

Forfeited/Lapsed

 

 

(38,075

)

 

20.03

 

 

(73,236

)

 

21.65

 

 

(71,786

)

 

18.75

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 

Outstanding at end of year

 

 

272,389

 

 

19.55

 

 

460,102

 

 

15.49

 

 

533,338

 

 

16.34

 

 

 



















Options exercisable at end of year

 

 

177,389

 

 

 

 

 

350,646

 

 

 

 

 

409,434

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 



 

 

 

 


 

 

[1]

As a result of retirements and terminations. Since these provisions were included in the original terms of the awards, these reclassifications are not considered modifications for accounting purposes.

At December 31, 2010, no qualified or NQSO stock options were outstanding, exercisable and in-the-money. The Company believes that all unvested stock options will ultimately vest.

The following table presents information regarding qualified and non-qualified stock options outstanding at December 31, 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Options Outstanding

 

Options Exercisable

 

 

 





 

 

Range of
Exercise
Prices

 

Number
Outstanding
at 12/31/10

 

Weighted-Average
Remaining
Contractual Life

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise
Price

 

Number
Exercisable
at 12/31/10

 

Weighted-Average
Exercise
Price

 















Qualified

 

$

10.61–14.60

 

 

150,358

 

 

1.06 years

 

$

14.43

 

 

143,502

 

$

14.43

 

Non-Qualified

 

 

14.60–26.94

 

 

272,389

 

 

2.58 years

 

 

19.55

 

 

177,389

 

 

20.39

 

Director NQSOs expire five years from the date of the grant and become exercisable in four annual installments, starting one year from the date of the grant, or upon the earlier of death or disability of the grantee. Employee stock options generally expire ten years from the date of the grant and vest one year from the date of grant. Although, if necessary to qualify to the maximum extent possible as ISOs, these options become exercisable in annual installments. Employee stock options which become exercisable over a period of more than one year are generally subject to earlier exercisability upon the termination of the grantee’s employment for any reason more than one year following grant. Amounts received upon exercise of options are recorded as common stock and capital surplus. The additional tax benefit received by the Company upon exercise of a NQSO is credited to capital surplus.

PAGE 94


There were no options granted during 2010, 2009 or 2008.

Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 718: Compensation—Stock Compensation, the Company recorded compensation expense of $109 thousand, $132 thousand and $132 thousand during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, for option awards in 2006 and 2007. As of December 31, 2010, the total remaining unrecognized compensation cost related to option awards was $103 thousand, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average vesting period of 1.2 years.

The tax benefit recognized as a credit to capital surplus upon the exercise of NQSOs amounted to approximately $66 thousand at December 31, 2010, $-0- at December 31, 2009 and $1.6 million at December 31, 2008.

Restricted Stock

On March 25, 2010, the Board of Directors, upon recommendation by the Compensation and Corporate Governance Committees, granted a total of 40,000 shares of restricted stock to the 8 non-management directors (“director restricted shares”) and 43,728 restricted shares to the Chairman, President, and 5 Executive Vice Presidents (“officer restricted shares”). The director restricted shares will vest 25% annually over four years beginning on the first anniversary of the grant date. The officer restricted shares vest 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date and 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversaries of the grant date and are also limited by the 2008 agreement between the Company and the U.S. Treasury. The director restricted shares and the officer restricted shares were issued at $9.23 per share, the closing price on the date of the grant. The agreement for both the director restricted shares and the officer restricted shares have additional provisions regarding transferability and accelerated vesting of the shares and the continuation of performing substantial services for the Company. As of December 31, 2010, all 83,728 shares were still issued and none were vested.

Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 718: Compensation—Stock Compensation, the Company recorded compensation expense of $149 thousand during the year ended December 31, 2010 and a related tax benefit of $68 thousand. As of December 31, 2010, the total remaining unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted stock awards was $624 thousand, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average vesting period of 3.2 years.

NOTE 20.

EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

Retirement Plans

The Company has a noncontributory, tax-qualified defined benefit pension plan that covers the majority of employees with one or more years of service of at least 1,000 hours, who are at least 21 years of age. The benefits are based upon years of credited service, primary social security benefits and a participant’s highest average compensation as defined. The funding requirements for the plan are determined annually based upon the amount needed to satisfy the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 funding standards. As of January 2, 2006, no new employees were eligible to enter the plan.

The Company also has a noncontributory, supplemental non-qualified, non-funded retirement plan which is designed to supplement the pension plan for key officers.

PAGE 95


The following tables, using a December 31 measurement date for each period presented, set forth the disclosures required for pension benefits:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

At or For the Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







CHANGE IN BENEFIT OBLIGATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Benefit obligation at beginning of year (Projected Benefit Obligation)

 

$

63,054

 

$

58,401

 

Service cost

 

 

2,050

 

 

2,160

 

Interest cost

 

 

3,766

 

 

3,355

 

Actuarial loss (gain)

 

 

4,607

 

 

608

 

Benefits paid

 

 

(2,507

)

 

(1,470

)

 

 







Benefit obligation at end of year

 

$

70,970

 

$

63,054

 

 

 







CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value of assets at beginning of year

 

$

38,010

 

$

30,699

 

Actual return on plan assets

 

 

4,284

 

 

6,751

 

Employer contributions

 

 

1,735

 

 

2,030

 

Benefits paid

 

 

(2,507

)

 

(1,470

)

 

 







Fair value of assets at end of year

 

$

41,522

 

$

38,010

 

 

 







Funded status

 

$

(29,448

)

$

(25,044

)

 

 







AMOUNTS RECOGNIZED IN THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS CONSIST OF:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pension liability

 

$

(29,448

)

$

(25,044

)

Accumulated other comprehensive loss (pre-tax)

 

 

23,588

 

 

23,073

 


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Discount Rate

 

Rate of
Compensation
Increase

 

 

 


 



 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2010

 

2009

 











WEIGHTED-AVERAGE ASSUMPTIONS USED TO DETERMINE THE BENEFIT OBLIGATION:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Defined benefit pension plan

 

 

5.50

%

 

6.00

%

 

3.00

%

 

3.00

%

Supplemental retirement plan

 

 

5.50

 

 

6.00

 

 

3.00

 

 

3.00

 

Components of the net periodic benefit expense and other amounts recognized in other comprehensive (income) loss are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 












COMPONENTS OF NET PERIODIC COST

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service cost

 

$

2,050

 

$

2,160

 

$

1,884

 

Interest cost

 

 

3,766

 

 

3,355

 

 

3,033

 

Expected return on plan assets

 

 

(3,020

)

 

(2,618

)

 

(2,581

)

Amortization of prior service cost

 

 

67

 

 

67

 

 

66

 

Recognized actuarial loss

 

 

2,672

 

 

3,454

 

 

1,557

 

 

 










Net periodic benefit expense

 

 

5,535

 

 

6,418

 

 

3,959

 

 

 










Other changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in other comprehensive loss (income):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net actuarial loss (income)

 

 

480

 

 

(3,822

)

 

6,763

 

Prior service credit

 

 

(36

)

 

(36

)

 

(36

)

 

 










Total recognized in other comprehensive loss (income)

 

 

444

 

 

(3,858

)

 

6,727

 

 

 










Total recognized in net periodic benefit expense and other comprehensive income or loss

 

$

5,979

 

$

2,560

 

$

10,686

 

 

 










PAGE 96



 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Discount Rate

 

Expected Return
on Plan Assets

 

Rate of Compensation
Increase

 

 

 


 


 



 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 






























WEIGHTED-AVERAGE ASSUMPTIONS USED TO DETERMINE NET PERIODIC COST:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Defined benefit pension plan

 

 

6.00

%

 

5.75

%

 

6.00

%

 

8.00

%

 

8.50

%

 

8.50

%

 

3.00

%

 

3.00

%

 

3.00

%

Supplemental retirement plan

 

 

6.00

 

 

5.75

 

 

6.00

 

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

 

3.00

 

 

3.00

 

 

3.00

 

To determine the expected return on plan assets, we consider historical return information on plan assets, the mix of investments that comprise plan assets and the actual income derived from plan assets.

The accumulated benefit obligation for the defined benefit pension plan at December 31, 2010 and 2009 was $42.9 million and $37.6 million, respectively.

The tables presented on the previous page and above include the supplemental retirement plan which is an unfunded plan. The following information is presented regarding the supplemental retirement plan:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







Projected benefit obligation

 

$

25,165

 

$

22,504

 

Accumulated benefit obligation

 

 

25,165

 

 

22,466

 

The following table sets forth information regarding the assets of the defined benefit pension plan:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







U.S. government corporation and agency debt obligations

 

 

4

%

 

6

%

Corporate debt obligation

 

 

28

 

 

30

 

Common equity securities

 

 

61

 

 

58

 

Other

 

 

7

 

 

6

 

 

 







Total

 

 

100

%

 

100

%

 

 







The Company’s overall investment strategy is to achieve a mix of approximately 50-60% of investments for long-term growth, and although the position will vary, generally limit to approximately 5% of the investments for near-term benefit payments and/or funds awaiting investment, within a diverse portfolio of asset types, strategies and management styles. The allocation of plan assets as of December 31, 2010 is shown in the table above. Equity securities primarily include investments in common stock. Debt securities include corporate and federal agency obligations. No real estate investments are held. Other investments consist of trust preferred securities.

The overall strategy of the Pension Plan Investment Policy is to have a diverse portfolio that reasonably spans established risk/return levels and preserves liquidity. The strategy allows for a moderate risk approach in order to achieve greater long-term asset growth. The asset mix can vary but is targeted at 50% equity securities, inclusive of up to 10% in the parent company common stock, 25% in corporate obligations and 25% in federal and agency obligations. The money market investments position will vary but will generally be held under 5%. The Plan’s allocation to common stock, excluding shares of the parent company, represents investment in those companies from time to time comprising the growth and value Model Portfolio as advised by the trustee’s investment advisor.

The weighted average expected long term rate of return is estimated based on current trends in the plan assets as well as projected future rates of returns on those assets. The long term rate of return considers historical returns, with adjustments to reflect expectations of future returns as determined by the trustee’s investment advisor after consultation with the trustee. These adjustments include consideration of projected future economic conditions, interest rates, industry trends and other factors.

The defined benefit pension plan owns common stock of the parent company which is included in common equity securities above. At December 31, 2010, the fair value of the parent company common stock was $723 thousand and represented approximately 2% of plan assets. At December 31, 2009, the fair value of the parent company common stock was $493 thousand and represented approximately 1% of plan assets.

PAGE 97


The defined benefit pension plan also owns capital securities (see Note 12 for definition) issued by Sterling Bancorp Trust I, a wholly-owned non-consolidated statutory business trust (which is a VIE). At December 31, 2010, the fair value of the capital securities was $1.2 million and represented approximately 3% of plan assets. At December 31, 2009, the fair value of the capital securities was approximately $1.1 million and represented approximately 3% of plan assets.

The Company expects to contribute approximately $2.0 million to the defined benefit pension plan in 2011.

The following table presents benefit payments expected to be paid, based on the assumption described below, including the effect of expected future service for the years indicated.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year(s)

 

Defined
Benefit Plan

 

Supplemental
Retirement Plan

 

Total
Benefit Payments

 









2011

 

$

1,929

 

$

58

 

$

1,987

 

2012

 

 

2,148

 

 

27,907

 

 

30,055

 

2013

 

 

2,389

 

 

38

 

 

2,427

 

2014

 

 

2,566

 

 

39

 

 

2,605

 

2015

 

 

2,741

 

 

501

 

 

3,242

 

Years 2016–2020

 

 

16,602

 

 

181

 

 

16,783

 

The cash flows shown above are based on the assumptions used in the annual actuarial valuations of the defined benefit plan. The supplemental retirement plan column is computed assuming that any executive who has reached the age upon which full retirement is assumed for actuarial purposes, actually retires in the current year. However, if such an executive does not actually retire in the current year, the obligation will be deferred until a later year. We are not aware of any senior executives who have near-term plans to retire.

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss, pre-tax, as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 follow:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Qualified Pension Plan

 

Supplemental
Retirement Plan

 

Total

 

 

 


 


 


 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2010

 

2009

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 












 

Net actuarial loss

 

$

17,131

 

$

16,285

 

$

6,352

 

$

6,527

 

$

23,483

 

$

22,812

 

Prior service cost

 

 

85

 

 

134

 

 

20

 

 

38

 

 

105

 

 

172

 

 

 


















 

Total

 

$

17,216

 

$

16,419

 

$

6,372

 

$

6,565

 

$

23,588

 

$

22,984

 

 

 


















 

The estimated costs that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive loss into net periodic cost in 2011 are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Qualified Pension Plan

 

Supplemental
Retirement Plan

 

Total

 

 

 







Net actuarial loss

 

$

1,634

 

$

872

 

$

2,506

 

Prior service cost

 

 

47

 

 

16

 

 

63

 

 

 









 

Total

 

$

1,681

 

$

888

 

$

2,569

 

 

 









 

Fair Value of Plan Assets: Fair value is the exchange price that would be received for an asset in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date.

PAGE 98


The Company used the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate the fair value of each type of financial instrument:

Equity, Debt, Investment Funds and Other Securities—The fair values for investment securities are determined by quoted market prices, if available (Level 1). For securities where quoted prices are not available, fair values are calculated based on market prices of similar securities (Level 2). For securities where quoted prices or market prices of similar securities are not available, fair values are calculated using discounted cash flows or other market indicators (Level 3). Discounted cash flows are calculated using spread to swap and LIBOR curves that are updated to incorporate loss severities, volatility, credit spread and optionality. During times when trading is more liquid, broker quotes are used (if available) to validate the model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as defaults and deferrals on individual securities are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations.

The fair value of the plan assets at December 31, 2010, by asset category, is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2010 Using:

 

 

 

 

 

 


 

 

 

Carrying
Value

 

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)

 

Significant Other
Observable
Inputs (Level 2)

 

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs (Level 3)

 














 

Plan Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

$

27,375

 

$

27,375

 

$

 

$

 

U.S. government agency obligations

 

 

1,685

 

 

1,685

 

 

 

 

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

11,493

 

 

11,493

 

 

 

 

 

Money market funds and other

 

 

969

 

 

 

 

969

 

 

 

 

 












 

Total Plan Assets

 

$

41,522

 

$

40,553

 

$

969

 

$

 

 

 












 

Savings Plans

As of January 1, 2008, the Company merged its two 401(k) plans into one plan (“new plan”). Eligible employees must complete 1,000 hours of service in order to be eligible for the Company matching contributions. Participants in the new plan eligible for Company matching contributions include any employee hired after January 1, 2006 and employees of two subsidiaries of the bank. Eligible employees may enroll in the new plan on the first day of the month after hire. The Company matches 25% of the eligible employee’s contribution to the plan based on the amount of each participant’s contributions, up to the Internal Revenue Service maximum contribution limit. All participants may immediately invest their individual contributions, as well as any Company matching contribution, in any of a variety of investment alternatives offered under the new plan. Expense for employer match related to the new plan totaled $323 thousand in 2010, $289 thousand in 2009 and $258 thousand in 2008.

Postretirement Life Insurance Benefits

The Company currently provides life insurance benefits to certain officers. The coverage provided depends upon years of service with the Company and the employee’s date of retirement. The Company’s plan for its postretirement benefit obligation is unfunded with a liability of $1.4 million at December 31, 2010 and $1.1 million at December 31, 2009. Net postretirement benefit cost was $65 thousand, $65 thousand and $61 thousand for 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

PAGE 99


FASB Codification Topic 715: Compensation—Retirement Benefits requires the recognition of a liability and related compensation expense for endorsement split-dollar life insurance arrangements that provide a benefit to an employee that extends to post-retirement periods. Under U.S. GAAP, life insurance policies purchased for the purpose of providing such benefits are considered not to have effectively settled an entity’s obligation to the employee. Accordingly, the entity must recognize a liability and related compensation expense during the employee’s active service period based on the future cost of insurance to be incurred during the employee’s retirement. If the entity has agreed to provide the employee with a death benefit, then the liability for the future death benefit should be recognized by following U.S. GAAP guidance in FASB Codification Topic 715: Compensation—Retirement Benefits. The Company adopted new accounting requirements related to bank-owned life insurance included in FASB Codification Topic 715: Compensation—Retirement Benefits on January 1, 2008 as a change in accounting principle through a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings totaling $726 thousand.

NOTE 21.

INCOME TAXES

The current and deferred tax provisions (benefits) applicable to income before taxes for each of the last three fiscal years are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









FEDERAL

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

3,615

 

$

9,187

 

$

6,770

 

Deferred

 

 

(1,734

)

 

(5,226

)

 

1,005

 

 

 










Total

 

$

1,881

 

$

3,961

 

$

7,775

 

 

 










STATE AND LOCAL

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

973

 

$

2,065

 

$

1,225

 

Deferred

 

 

(696

)

 

(1,118

)

 

176

 

 

 










Total

 

$

277

 

$

947

 

$

1,401

 

 

 










TOTAL

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

4,588

 

$

11,252

 

$

7,995

 

Deferred

 

 

(2,430

)

 

(6,344

)

 

1,181

 

 

 










Total

 

$

2,158

 

$

4,908

 

$

9,176

 

 

 










Reconciliations of income tax provisions with taxes computed at Federal statutory rates are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Federal statutory rate

 

 

34

%

 

35

%

 

35

%

 

 










Computed tax based on income from continuing operations

 

$

3,123

 

$

5,015

 

$

8,814

 

Increase (Decrease) in tax resulting from:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

State and local taxes, net of Federal income tax benefit

 

 

218

 

 

673

 

 

911

 

Tax-exempt income

 

 

(1,640

)

 

(648

)

 

(678

)

Other permanent items

 

 

457

 

 

(132

)

 

129

 

 

 










Total

 

$

2,158

 

$

4,908

 

$

9,176

 

 

 










PAGE 100


The components of the net deferred tax asset, included in other assets, are as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







Deferred tax assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Difference between financial statement provision for loan losses and tax bad debt deduction

 

$

8,275

 

$

9,017

 

Pension and benefit plans

 

 

10,796

 

 

10,452

 

Other

 

 

5,262

 

 

2,782

 

 

 






 

Total deferred tax assets

 

 

24,333

 

 

22,251

 

 

 






 

Deferred tax liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Difference between tax and net book values of fixed assets

 

 

738

 

 

767

 

Available for sale securities and other investments deferred tax liability

 

 

156

 

 

203

 

Other

 

 

534

 

 

1,014

 

 

 






 

Total deferred tax liabilities

 

 

1,428

 

 

1,984

 

 

 






 

Net deferred tax asset

 

$

22,905

 

$

20,267

 

 

 






 

Based on management’s consideration of historical and anticipated future pre-tax income, as well as the reversal period for the items giving rise to the deferred tax assets and liabilities, a valuation allowance for deferred assets was not considered necessary at December 31, 2010 and 2009 since it is more likely than not that these assets will be realized.

The current tax net payable as of December 31, 2010 was approximately $1.6 million. The current tax net payable at December 31, 2009 was approximately $1.5 million.

The Company has no uncertain tax positions. The Company recognizes interest accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits and penalties in noninterest operating expenses. At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Consolidated Balance Sheet included no accrued interest related to unrecognized tax benefits and the Consolidated Statement of Income for 2010 included $-0- for interest expense, for 2009 included $-0- for interest expense and for 2008 included a credit for interest expense of $148 thousand.

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to U.S. federal income tax as well as income tax of multiple state jurisdictions. The Company’s federal income tax returns for 2002 through 2008 are currently under examination and 2009 is subject to examination. The Company’s New York State tax returns for years 2005 through 2007 are currently under examination and 2008 and 2009 are subject to examination. The Company’s New York City tax returns for 2006 through 2009 are subject to examination.

NOTE 22.

EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE

Earnings per common share is computed using the two-class method. Basic earnings per common share is computed by dividing net earnings allocated to common stock by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the applicable period, excluding participating securities. Participating securities include non-vested stock awards such as awards of restricted shares of common stock. Non-vested stock awards are considered participating securities because holders of these securities receive non-forfeitable dividends at the same rate as holders of the Company’s common stock. Diluted earnings per common share is computed using the weighted-average number of shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive effect of stock compensation using the treasury stock method.

PAGE 101


The following table presents the calculation of net earnings allocated to common stock and a reconciliation of the number of shares used in the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 








 

Distributed earnings allocated to common stock

 

$

8,851

 

$

10,131

 

$

13,675

 

Undistributed earnings allocated to common stock

 

 

(4,429

)

 

(3,482

)

 

2,229

 

 

 









 

Net earnings allocated to common stock

 

$

4,422

 

$

6,649

 

$

15,904

 

 

 









 

Weighted average common shares outstanding

 

 

24,492,279

 

 

18,104,619

 

 

17,890,997

 

Add dilutive effect of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stock options

 

 

2,765

 

 

21,714

 

 

216,881

 

 

 









 

Adjusted for assumed diluted computation

 

 

24,495,044

 

 

18,126,333

 

 

18,107,878

 

 

 









 

Options issued with exercise prices greater than the average market price of the common shares for each of the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 have not been included in computation of diluted EPS for those respective years. As of December 31, 2010, 422,747 options to purchase shares between $10.61 and $26.94 were not included; as of December 31, 2009, 460,822 options to purchase shares between $10.61 and $26.94 were not included; as of December 31, 2008, 531,601 options to purchase shares between $14.60 and $26.94 were not included.

NOTE 23.

FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS

The fair value of an asset or liability is the price that would be receivable from selling that asset or payable to transfer that liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability occurs in the principal market for the asset or liability or, in the absence of a principal market, the most advantageous market for the asset or liability. The price in the principal (or most advantageous) market used to measure the fair value of the asset or liability shall not be adjusted for transaction costs. An orderly transaction is a transaction that assumes exposure to the market for a period prior to the measurement date to allow for marketing activities that are usual and customary for transactions involving such assets and liabilities; it is not a forced transaction. Market participants are buyers and sellers in the principal market that are independent, knowledgeable, able to transact and willing to transact.

FASB Codification Topic 820: Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures establishes a hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair values hierarchy is as follows:

 

 

Level 1 Inputs—Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the reporting entity has the ability to access at the measurement date. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are U.S. Treasury securities, equity and trust preferred securities that trade in active markets and listed derivative instruments.

 

 

Level 2 Inputs—Inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. These might include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability (such as interest rates, volatilities, prepayment speeds, credit risks, etc.) or inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by market data by correlation or other means. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are corporate debt, mortgage-backed certificates issued by U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises, equity securities that trade in less active markets and certain derivative instruments.

 

 

Level 3 Inputs—Unobservable inputs for determining the fair values of assets or liabilities that reflect an entity’s own judgments about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the assets or liabilities. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are private equities, certain loans held for sale and other alternative investments.

In general, fair value of securities is based upon quoted market prices, where available (Level 1 inputs). If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon market prices determined by an outside, independent entity that primarily uses as inputs, observable market-based parameters (Level 2 inputs). Fair value of loans held for sale is based upon internally developed models that primarily use as inputs, observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments may include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality and the Company’s creditworthiness, among other things, as well as unobservable parameters (Level 3 inputs). Any such valuation adjustments are applied consistently over time. The Company’s valuation methodologies may produce a fair value calculation that

PAGE 102


may not be indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.

Securities available for sale and other investments. Securities classified as available for sale and other investments (included in “Other assets” on the Consolidated Balance Sheet) are generally reported at fair value utilizing Level 1 and Level 2 inputs. Investments in fixed income securities, exclusive of preferred stock and mortgage-backed securities, are valued based on evaluations provided by Interactive Data Corporation (“IDC”), a leading global provider of market data information. IDC evaluations represent an exit price or their opinion as to what a buyer would pay for a security, typically in an institutional round lot position in a current sale. IDC seeks to utilize market data and observations in its evaluation service, and gives priority to observable benchmark yields and reported trades. IDC utilizes evaluated pricing techniques that vary by asset class and incorporate available market information; because many fixed income securities do not trade on a daily basis, IDC applies available information through processes such as benchmark curves, benchmarking of similar securities, sector groupings and matrix pricing. Model processes such as option-adjusted spread models are used to value securities that have prepayment features. Substantially all securities available for sale evaluated in this manner are deemed to be Level 2 valuations.

For mortgage-backed securities issued by U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises, management considers dealer indicative bids in the valuation process. Indicative bids are estimates of value and do not necessarily represent the price at which the dealer would be willing to transact. Such bids are compared to IDC evaluated prices for reasonableness as well as consistency with observable market conditions. All mortgage-backed securities are deemed to be valued based on Level 2 inputs.

Publicly traded common and preferred stocks are valued by reference to the market closing price (last trade) on the measurement date (Level 1 inputs). In the unlikely event that no trade occurred on the measurement date, reference would be made to an indicative bid or the last trade most proximate to the measurement date (Level 2 inputs).

The following table summarizes financial assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value. There were no financial liabilities measured at fair value.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Level 1
Inputs

 

Level 2
Inputs

 

Level 3
Inputs

 

Total
Fair Value

 















December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities available for sale:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage-backed securities

 

$

 

$

51,983

 

$

 

$

51,983

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

100,122

 

 

 

 

100,122

 

 

 













Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

152,105

 

 

 

 

152,105

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

 

 

40,044

 

 

 

 

40,044

 

Single-issuer, trust preferred securities

 

 

3,933

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,933

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

 

 

189,058

 

 

 

 

189,058

 

Equity and other securities

 

 

4,940

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,940

 

 

 













Total marketable securities

 

$

8,873

 

$

381,207

 

$

 

$

390,080

 

 

 













Other investments

 

$

11,838

 

$

6,760

 

$

 

$

18,598

 

 

 













 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities available for sale:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage-backed securities

 

$

 

$

57,288

 

$

 

$

57,288

 

Agency notes

 

 

 

 

131,635

 

 

 

 

131,635

 

 

 













Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

188,923

 

 

 

 

188,923

 

Obligations of state and political institutions

 

 

 

 

23,864

 

 

 

 

23,864

 

Single-issuer, trust preferred securities

 

 

4,483

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,483

 

Corporate debt securities

 

 

 

 

129,200

 

 

 

 

129,200

 

Equity and other securities

 

 

56

 

 

 

 

 

 

56

 

 

 













Total marketable securities

 

$

4,539

 

$

341,987

 

$

 

$

346,526

 

 

 













Other investments

 

$

9,128

 

$

5,484

 

$

 

$

14,612

 

 

 













PAGE 103


Certain financial assets, such as loans held for sale and collateral-dependent impaired loans are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment). The following table summarizes the period end fair value of financial assets, based on significant unobservable (Level 3) inputs, measured on a non-recurring basis:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,
2010

 

December 31,
2009

 









Impaired loans

 

$

7,836

 

$

4,855

 

Other real estate owned, net

 

 

182

 

 

1,385

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

 

33,889

 

Impaired loans. The fair value of impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses is generally based on either recent real estate appraisals or, for loans with modification agreements in place, discounted cash flow analyses. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments are usually significant and typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value.

Other real estate owned. Nonrecurring adjustments to certain residential real estate properties classified as other real estate owned (“OREO”) are measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value, less costs to sell. Fair values are generally based on third party appraisals of the property, resulting in a Level 3 classification. In cases where the carrying amount exceeds the fair value, less costs to sell, an impairment loss is recognized.

Loans held for sale. Loans held for sale are carried at the lower of cost or fair value, as determined by outstanding commitments, from third party investors.

Impaired loans had a net carrying amount of $10.7 million, net of a specific allocation of the allowance for loan losses of $2.8 million, at December 31, 2010. The fair value of an impaired loan is estimated using Level 2 inputs based on observable market data or Level 3 inputs based on customized discount criteria. During 2010, the Company recongnized charge-offs in the allowance for loan losses totalling $1.2 million.

Other real estate owned (comprised of foreclosed assets), which is measured at the lower of carrying or fair value less costs to sell, had a net carrying amount of $182 thousand, net of a valuation allowance of $-0- million at December 31, 2010. Certain of these assets, upon initial recognition, were re-measured and reported at fair value through a charge-off to the allowance for loan losses based upon the fair value of the foreclosed asset. The fair value of a foreclosed asset, upon initial recognition, is estimated using Level 2 inputs based on observable market data or Level 3 inputs based on customized discount criteria. In connection with the measurement and initial recognition of the foregoing foreclosed assets, the Company recognized charge-offs in the allowance for loan losses totalling $538 thousand. Other than foreclosed assets measured at fair value upon initial recognition, two properties were re-measured at fair value during the year ended December 31, 2010, resulting in a $233 thousand charge to noninterest expense.

Loans held for sale, which are carried at $32.0 million, which is made up of the outstanding balance of $32.1 million, net of a valuation allowance of $0.1 million at December 31, 2010.

For those financial instruments that are not recorded at fair value in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, but are measured at fair value for disclosure purposes, management follows the same fair value measurement principles and guidance as for instruments recorded at fair value.

Much of the information used to arrive at “fair value” is highly subjective and judgmental in nature and therefore the results may not be precise. The subjective factors include, among other things, estimated cash flows, risk characteristics, credit quality and interest rates, all of which are subject to change. With the exception of investment securities and certain long-term debt, the Company’s financial instruments are not readily marketable and market prices do not exist. Since negotiated prices for the instruments that are not readily marketable depend greatly on the motivation of the buyer and seller, the amounts that will actually be realized or paid per settlement or maturity of these instruments could be significantly different.

PAGE 104


In particular, fair value estimates are made at a point in time, based on relevant market data as well as the best information available about the financial instrument. Illiquid credit markets have resulted in inactive markets for certain of the Company’s financial instruments. As a result, there is no or limited observable market data for these assets and liabilities. Fair value estimates for financial instruments for which no or limited observable market data is available are based on our judgments regarding current economic conditions, liquidity discounts, currency, credit, and interest rate risks, loss experience and other factors, all of which are Level 3 inputs as discussed above. These estimates involve significant judgments and uncertainties and cannot be substantiated by comparison to quoted prices in active markets and cannot be determined with precision. As a result, such calculated fair value estimates may not be realizable in a current sale or immediate settlement of the instrument. In addition, there are inherent uncertainties in any fair value measurement technique, and changes in the underlying assumptions used in the fair value measurement technique, including discount rates, liquidity risks, and estimates of future cash flows, could significantly affect these fair value estimates.

A description of the methods, factors and significant assumptions utilized in estimating the fair values for significant categories of financial instruments follows:

Financial Instruments with Carrying Amounts Equal to Fair Value

The carrying amounts for cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits with other banks, customers’ liabilities under acceptances, accrued interest receivable, Federal funds purchased, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, commercial paper, other short-term borrowings, acceptances outstanding, and accrued interest payable, as a result of their short-term nature, are considered to approximate fair value.

Investment Securities

The methods, factors and significant assumptions used to estimate fair values of all securities are described more fully beginning on page 102.

Loans Held in Portfolio

The fair value of loans held in portfolio which reprice within 90 days reflecting changes in the base rate approximate their carrying amount. For other loans held in portfolio, the fair value is calculated based on discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality and for similar maturities. These calculations have been adjusted for credit risk based on the Company’s historical credit loss experience.

The fair value for secured nonaccrual loans is the value of the underlying collateral which is sufficient to repay each loan. For other nonaccrual loans, the fair value represents book value less a credit risk adjustment based on the Company’s historical credit loss experience.

Deposits

FASB Codification Topic 825: Financial Instruments requires that the fair value of demand, savings, NOW (negotiable order of withdrawal) and certain money market deposits be equal to their carrying amount. The Company believes that the fair value of these deposits, including the value of deposit relationships, is greater than that prescribed by FASB Codification Topic 825.

For other types of deposits with fixed maturities, fair value has been estimated based upon interest rates currently being offered on deposits with similar characteristics and maturities.

Advances—FHLB and Long-Term Borrowings

For advances—FHLB and long-term borrowings, the fair value is calculated based on discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being quoted for debt with similar characteristics and maturities.

Commitments to Extend Credit, Standby Letters of Credit and Financial Guarantees

The fees received for the issuance of commitments to extend credit, standby letters of credit, and financial guarantees, are considered to approximate fair value. Due to the uncertainty involved in attempting to assess the likelihood and timing of a commitment being drawn upon, coupled with lack of an established market and the wide diversity of fee structures, the Company does not believe it is meaningful to provide an estimate of fair value that differs from the amount of consideration received.

PAGE 105


The following is a summary of the carrying amounts and fair values of the Company’s financial assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 






 

 

 

Carrying
Amount

 

Fair
Value

 

Carrying
Amount

 

Fair
Value

 










 

FINANCIAL ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks

 

$

26,824

 

$

26,824

 

$

24,911

 

$

24,911

 

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

 

 

40,503

 

 

40,503

 

 

36,958

 

 

36,958

 

Investment securities

 

 

789,315

 

 

790,533

 

 

737,065

 

 

742,676

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

32,049

 

 

32,049

 

 

33,889

 

 

33,889

 

Loans held in portfolio, net

 

 

1,295,996

 

 

1,300,624

 

 

1,175,543

 

 

1,170,385

 

Customers’ liability under acceptances

 

 

 

 

 

 

27

 

 

27

 

Accrued interest receivable

 

 

8,280

 

 

8,280

 

 

9,001

 

 

9,001

 

FINANCIAL LIABILITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Demand, NOW, savings and money market deposits

 

 

1,132,497

 

 

1,132,497

 

 

1,138,352

 

 

1,138,352

 

Time deposits

 

 

615,267

 

 

617,096

 

 

442,315

 

 

444,792

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

 

28,016

 

 

28,016

 

 

21,048

 

 

21,048

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

15,000

 

 

15,000

 

 

41,000

 

 

41,000

 

Commercial paper

 

 

14,388

 

 

14,388

 

 

17,297

 

 

17,297

 

Short-term borrowings—FRB

 

 

 

 

 

 

50,000

 

 

50,000

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

 

3,490

 

 

3,490

 

 

2,509

 

 

2,509

 

Acceptances outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

27

 

 

27

 

Accrued interest payable

 

 

1,314

 

 

1,314

 

 

1,291

 

 

1,291

 

Advances—FHLB and long-term borrowings

 

 

169,947

 

 

173,110

 

 

155,774

 

 

159,042

 

PAGE 106


NOTE 24.

CAPITAL MATTERS

The Company and the bank are subject to risk-based capital regulations which quantitatively measure capital against risk-weighted assets, including certain off-balance sheet items. These regulations define the elements of the Tier 1 and Tier 2 components of Total Capital and establish minimum ratios of 4% for Tier 1 capital and 8% for Total Capital for capital adequacy purposes. Supplementing these regulations is a leverage requirement. This requirement establishes a minimum leverage ratio (at least 3% or 4%, depending upon an institution’s regulatory status), which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by adjusted quarterly average assets (after deducting goodwill). In addition, the bank is subject to the provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”) which imposes a number of mandatory supervisory measures. Among other matters, FDICIA established five capital categories ranging from “well capitalized” to “critically undercapitalized.” Such classifications are used by regulatory agencies to determine a bank’s deposit insurance premium, approval of applications authorizing institutions to increase their asset size or otherwise expand business activities or acquire other institutions. Under FDICIA a “well capitalized” bank must maintain minimum leverage, Tier 1 and Total Capital ratios of 5%, 6% and 10%, respectively. The Federal Reserve Board applies comparable tests for holding companies such as the Company. At December 31, 2010, management believes that the Company and the bank exceeded the requirements for “well capitalized” institutions under the tests pursuant to FDICIA and of the Federal Reserve Board.

The following tables present information regarding the Company’s and the bank’s regulatory capital ratios:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Actual

 

Minimum For Capital Adequacy

 

To Be Well Capitalized

 

 

 







As of December 31, 2010

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 















Total Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

$

255,022

 

 

14.68

%

$

138,982

 

 

8.00

%

$

173,728

 

 

10.00

%

The bank

 

 

211,737

 

 

12.32

 

 

137,516

 

 

8.00

 

 

171,895

 

 

10.00

 

Tier 1 Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

 

236,477

 

 

13.61

 

 

69,491

 

 

4.00

 

 

104,237

 

 

6.00

 

The bank

 

 

193,192

 

 

11.24

 

 

68,758

 

 

4.00

 

 

103,137

 

 

6.00

 

Tier 1 Leverage Capital (to Average Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

 

236,477

 

 

10.15

 

 

93,152

 

 

4.00

 

 

116,440

 

 

5.00

 

The bank

 

 

193,192

 

 

8.39

 

 

92,070

 

 

4.00

 

 

115,087

 

 

5.00

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 





















Total Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

$

193,760

 

 

12.75

%

$

121,606

 

 

8.00

%

$

152,007

 

 

10.00

%

The bank

 

 

169,353

 

 

11.25

 

 

120,378

 

 

8.00

 

 

150,473

 

 

10.00

 

Tier 1 Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

 

174,746

 

 

11.50

 

 

60,803

 

 

4.00

 

 

91,204

 

 

6.00

 

The bank

 

 

150,529

 

 

10.00

 

 

60,189

 

 

4.00

 

 

90,284

 

 

6.00

 

Tier 1 Leverage Capital (to Average Assets):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company

 

 

174,746

 

 

8.06

 

 

86,757

 

 

4.00

 

 

108,447

 

 

5.00

 

The bank

 

 

150,529

 

 

6.97

 

 

86,385

 

 

4.00

 

 

107,981

 

 

5.00

 

PAGE 107


NOTE 25.

SEGMENT REPORTING

The Company provides a broad range of financial products and services, including commercial loans, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, asset-based financing, mortgage warehouse lending, factoring/accounts receivable management services, trade financing, equipment leasing, and corporate and consumer deposit services. The Company’s primary source of earnings is net interest income, which represents the difference between interest earned on interest-earning assets and the interest incurred on interest-bearing liabilities. The Company’s 2010 average interest-earning assets were 61.0% loans (corporate lending was 73.1% and real estate lending was 23.1% of total loans, respectively) and 37.1% investment securities and money market investments. There were no industry concentrations (exceeding 10% of loans, gross) in the corporate loan portfolio. Approximately 69% of loans were to borrowers located in the New York metropolitan area. In order to comply with the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 280: Segment Reporting, the Company has determined that it has three reportable operating segments: corporate lending, real estate lending and company-wide treasury.

Recent economic conditions during 2010 and 2009, such as continuing decrease in real estate values, general slowdown in spending and illiquid credit markets, have reduced demands for corporate and real estate lending. As such, it is reasonably possible that the income from corporate and real estate lending segments will decrease significantly from the current levels in the near term. In addition, due to the geographic concentration of the Company’s loan portfolio to the New York metropolitan area, an adverse change in market conditions in that geographic area could result in a significant decrease in our income from lending segments. Such decrease in income from lending segments, if realized, may have a severe adverse impact on the operations of the Company.

The following table provides certain information regarding the Company’s operating segments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Corporate
Lending

 

Real Estate
Lending

 

Company-wide
Treasury

 

Totals

 











Year Ended December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

$

39,914

 

$

18,390

 

$

22,423

 

$

80,727

 

Noninterest income

 

 

33,166

 

 

8,379

 

 

5,573

 

 

47,118

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

654

 

 

110

 

 

3

 

 

767

 

Segment income before income taxes

 

 

26,226

 

 

13,670

 

 

26,565

 

 

66,461

 

Segment assets

 

 

896,612

 

 

424,730

 

 

988,735

 

 

2,310,077

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

$

38,249

 

$

19,688

 

$

27,893

 

$

85,830

 

Noninterest income

 

 

26,011

 

 

9,550

 

 

7,956

 

 

43,517

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

677

 

 

135

 

 

3

 

 

815

 

Segment income before income taxes

 

 

27,045

 

 

16,794

 

 

33,718

 

 

77,557

 

Segment assets

 

 

820,167

 

 

372,842

 

 

931,642

 

 

2,124,651

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

$

36,637

 

$

20,824

 

$

26,353

 

$

83,814

 

Noninterest income (loss)

 

 

22,269

 

 

8,795

 

 

(164

)

 

30,900

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

749

 

 

261

 

 

3

 

 

1,013

 

Segment income from continuing operations before income taxes

 

 

27,829

 

 

13,436

 

 

25,347

 

 

66,612

 

Segment assets from continuing operations

 

 

819,940

 

 

394,513

 

 

934,286

 

 

2,148,739

 

PAGE 108


The following table sets forth reconciliations of net interest income, noninterest income, pre-tax income from continuing operations and total assets for reportable operating segments to the Company’s consolidated totals:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









Net interest income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total for reportable operating segments

 

$

80,727

 

$

85,830

 

$

83,814

 

Other[1]

 

 

880

 

 

795

 

 

869

 

 

 










Consolidated net interest income

 

$

81,607

 

$

86,625

 

$

84,683

 

 

 










Noninterest income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total for reportable operating segments

 

$

47,118

 

$

43,517

 

$

30,900

 

Other[1]

 

 

515

 

 

633

 

 

2,400

 

 

 










Consolidated noninterest income

 

$

47,633

 

$

44,150

 

$

33,300

 

 

 










Income from continuing operations before income taxes:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total for reportable operating segments

 

$

66,461

 

$

77,557

 

$

66,612

 

Other[1]

 

$

(57,277

)

 

(63,227

)

 

(41,430

)

 

 










Consolidated income/loss from continuing operations before income taxes

 

$

9,184

 

$

14,330

 

$

25,182

 

 

 










Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total for reportable operating segments

 

$

2,310,077

 

$

2,124,651

 

$

2,148,739

 

Other[1]

 

 

50,380

 

 

40,958

 

 

30,362

 

 

 










Consolidated assets

 

$

2,360,457

 

$

2,165,609

 

$

2,179,101

 

 

 










[1] Represents operations not considered to be a reportable segment and/or general operating expenses of the company.

NOTE 26.

PARENT COMPANY

CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 







ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks—

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Banking subsidiary

 

$

37,285

 

$

3,077

 

Other banks

 

 

32

 

 

36

 

Interest-bearing deposits—banking subsidiary

 

 

3,443

 

 

27,941

 

Securities available for sale (at fair value)

 

 

6,086

 

 

978

 

Loans, net of unearned discount

 

 

15,370

 

 

15,161

 

Investment in subsidiaries—

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Banking subsidiary (including goodwill of $22,901 in 2010 and 2009)

 

 

206,818

 

 

165,149

 

Other subsidiaries

 

 

2,160

 

 

2,138

 

Cash surrender value of life insurance policies

 

 

4,104

 

 

3,760

 

Other assets

 

 

15,856

 

 

11,785

 

 

 







 

 

$

291,154

 

$

230,025

 

 

 







 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial paper

 

$

14,388

 

$

17,297

 

Due to subsidiaries—

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other subsidiaries

 

 

992

 

 

992

 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

 

27,258

 

 

24,012

 

Junior subordinated debt (see Note 12)

 

 

25,774

 

 

25,774

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

222,742

 

 

161,950

 

 

 







 

 

$

291,154

 

$

230,025

 

 

 







PAGE 109


CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends and interest from—

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Banking subsidiary

 

$

2

 

$

39

 

$

12,558

 

Loans

 

 

208

 

 

95

 

 

150

 

Securities available for sale

 

 

342

 

 

88

 

 

66

 

Other income

 

 

155

 

 

172

 

 

463

 

 

 










Total income

 

 

707

 

 

394

 

 

13,237

 

 

 










EXPENSE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest expense

 

 

2,189

 

 

2,211

 

 

2,617

 

Other expenses

 

 

3,373

 

 

3,301

 

 

3,820

 

 

 










Total expense

 

 

5,562

 

 

5,512

 

 

6,437

 

 

 










(Loss) Income before income taxes and equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries

 

 

(4,855

)

 

(5,118

)

 

6,800

 

Benefit for income taxes

 

 

(1,147

)

 

(1,755

)

 

(2,215

)

 

 










(Loss) Income before equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries

 

 

(3,708

)

 

(3,363

)

 

9,015

 

Equity in undistributed net income (loss) of—

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Banking subsidiary

 

 

10,713

 

 

12,764

 

 

6,965

 

Other subsidiaries

 

 

21

 

 

21

 

 

26

 

 

 










Net income

 

$

7,026

 

$

9,422

 

$

16,006

 

 

 










PAGE 110


CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Years Ended December 31,

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 









OPERATING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

7,026

 

$

9,422

 

$

16,006

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease) in accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

 

3,246

 

 

(512

)

 

5,377

 

Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries

 

 

(10,734

)

 

(12,785

)

 

(6,991

)

Security gains

 

 

(15

)

 

 

 

 

Increase in other assets

 

 

(4,415

)

 

(2,028

)

 

(2,501

)

Other, net

 

 

1,028

 

 

(97

)

 

(887

)

 

 










Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities

 

 

(3,864

)

 

(6,000

)

 

11,004

 

 

 










INVESTING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net decrease (increase) in interest-bearing deposits—banking subsidiary

 

 

24,498

 

 

(17,039

)

 

4,490

 

Purchase of securities available for sale

 

 

(62,495

)

 

 

 

(786

)

(Increase) decrease in loans

 

 

(209

)

 

(15,111

)

 

4,751

 

Proceeds from sales/calls of securities available for sale

 

 

54,318

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from maturities and redemptions of securities available for sale

 

 

2,054

 

 

 

 

 

Investment in subsidiaries—banking subsidiary

 

 

(31,500

)

 

 

 

 

Decrease in due to subsidiaries, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

(53

)

Cash transferred on dissolution of subsidiary

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,996

 

 

 










Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities

 

 

(13,334

)

 

(32,150

)

 

10,398

 

 

 










FINANCING ACTIVITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net (decrease) increase in commercial paper

 

 

(2,909

)

 

5,565

 

 

(9,147

)

Cash dividends paid on common shares

 

 

(8,873

)

 

(10,131

)

 

(13,674

)

Cash dividends paid on preferred shares

 

 

(2,100

)

 

(1,878

)

 

 

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

 

403

 

 

197

 

 

2,589

 

Net proceeds from issuance of common stock

 

 

64,881

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock and warrant to purchase common stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

42,000

 

 

 










Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

 

51,402

 

 

(6,247

)

 

21,768

 

 

 










Net increase (decrease) in cash and due from banks

 

 

34,204

 

 

(44,397

)

 

43,170

 

Cash and due from banks—beginning of year

 

 

3,113

 

 

47,510

 

 

4,340

 

 

 










Cash and due from banks—end of year

 

$

37,317

 

$

3,113

 

$

47,510

 

 

 










Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest paid

 

$

2,174

 

$

2,214

 

$

2,734

 

Income taxes paid

 

 

3,994

 

 

5,757

 

 

9,178

 

PAGE 111


NOTE 27.

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

Total rental expenses under cancelable and noncancelable leases for premises and equipment were $5.8 million, $5.2 million and $5.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, which are net of rental income for a sublease of $218 thousand, $194 thousand and $204 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

The future minimum rental commitments as of December 31, 2010 under noncancelable leases follow:

 

 

 

 

 

Year(s)

 

Rental
Commitments

 





2011

 

$

4,843

 

2012

 

 

4,481

 

2013

 

 

4,479

 

2014

 

 

4,747

 

2015

 

 

4,550

 

2016 and thereafter

 

 

26,626

 

 

 



 

Total

 

$

49,726

 

 

 



 

Certain leases included above have escalation clauses and/or provide that the Company pay maintenance, electric, taxes and other operating expenses applicable to the leased property.

In the normal course of business, there are various commitments and contingent liabilities outstanding which are properly not recorded on the balance sheet. Management does not anticipate that losses, if any, as a result of these transactions would materially affect the financial position of the Company.

Loan commitments, approximately 89% of which have an original maturity of one year or less, were approximately $86.1 million as of December 31, 2010. These commitments are agreements to lend to a customer as long as the conditions established in the contract are met. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements because some of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon. The bank evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary, by the bank upon extension of credit is based on management’s credit evaluation of the borrower. Collateral held varies but may include cash, U.S. Treasury and other marketable securities, accounts receivable, inventory and property, plant and equipment.

Standby letters of credit and financial guarantees, substantially all of which are within the scope of FASB Codification Topic 460: Guarantees, are written conditional commitments issued by the bank to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. At December 31, 2010, these commitments totaled $26.0 million of which $19.4 million expire within one year and $6.6 million within two years. Approximately 75% of the commitments are automatically renewable for a period of one year. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The bank holds cash or cash equivalents and marketable securities as collateral supporting those commitments for which collateral is deemed necessary. The extent of collateral held for those commitments at December 31, 2010 ranged from 0% to 100%; the average amount collateralized was approximately 85%.

In the normal course of business there are various legal proceedings pending against the Company. Management, after consulting with counsel, is of the opinion that there should be no material liability with respect to such proceedings, and accordingly no provision has been made in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

PAGE 112


NOTE 28.

QUARTERLY DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010 Quarter

 

Mar 31

 

Jun 30

 

Sept 30

 

Dec 31

 











Total interest income

 

$

24,016

 

$

24,475

 

$

24,702

 

$

23,997

 

Total interest expense

 

 

4,121

 

 

3,937

 

 

3,827

 

 

3,698

 

Net interest income

 

 

19,895

 

 

20,538

 

 

20,875

 

 

20,299

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

6,000

 

 

5,500

 

 

14,000

 

 

3,000

 

Net securities gains

 

 

1,502

 

 

746

 

 

1,171

 

 

509

 

Noninterest income, excluding securities gains

 

 

9,600

 

 

10,615

 

 

11,887

 

 

11,603

 

Noninterest expenses

 

 

21,336

 

 

22,139

 

 

23,753

 

 

24,328

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

 

3,661

 

 

4,260

 

 

(3,820

)

 

5,083

 

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

 

 

1,098

 

 

1,278

 

 

(1,146

)

 

928

 

Net income (loss)

 

 

2,563

 

 

2,982

 

 

(2,674

)

 

4,155

 

Dividends on preferred shares and accretion

 

 

636

 

 

644

 

 

654

 

 

655

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders

 

 

1,927

 

 

2,338

 

 

(3,328

)

 

3,500

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders, per average common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

0.10

 

 

0.09

 

 

(0.12

)

 

0.13

 

Diluted

 

 

0.10

 

 

0.09

 

 

(0.12

)

 

0.13

 

Common stock closing price:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

High

 

 

10.05

 

 

10.93

 

 

10.28

 

 

10.59

 

Low

 

 

7.27

 

 

8.99

 

 

8.39

 

 

8.71

 

Quarter-end

 

 

10.05

 

 

9.00

 

 

8.69

 

 

10.47

 


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2009 Quarter

 

Mar 31

 

Jun 30

 

Sept 30

 

Dec 31

 











Total interest income

 

$

26,585

 

$

26,202

 

$

26,722

 

$

26,411

 

Total interest expense

 

 

5,218

 

 

4,888

 

 

4,753

 

 

4,436

 

Net interest income

 

 

21,367

 

 

21,314

 

 

21,969

 

 

21,975

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

6,200

 

 

6,800

 

 

6,950

 

 

7,950

 

Net securities gains

 

 

3,065

 

 

874

 

 

1,221

 

 

401

 

Noninterest income, excluding securities gains

 

 

7,739

 

 

9,924

 

 

10,514

 

 

10,412

 

Noninterest expenses

 

 

20,052

 

 

24,143

 

 

23,177

 

 

21,173

 

Income before income taxes

 

 

5,919

 

 

1,169

 

 

3,577

 

 

3,665

 

Provision for income taxes

 

 

2,306

 

 

394

 

 

1,180

 

 

1,028

 

Net income

 

 

3,613

 

 

775

 

 

2,397

 

 

2,637

 

Dividends on preferred shares and accretion

 

 

842

 

 

637

 

 

646

 

 

648

 

Net income available to common shareholders

 

 

2,771

 

 

138

 

 

1,751

 

 

1,989

 

Net income available to common shareholders, per average common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

0.15

 

 

0.01

 

 

0.10

 

 

0.11

 

Diluted

 

 

0.15

 

 

0.01

 

 

0.10

 

 

0.11

 

Common stock closing price:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

High

 

 

13.86

 

 

12.27

 

 

9.55

 

 

7.30

 

Low

 

 

7.23

 

 

7.92

 

 

6.40

 

 

6.29

 

Quarter-end

 

 

9.90

 

 

8.35

 

 

7.22

 

 

7.14

 

PAGE 113


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

(CROWE HORWATH LOGO)

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Sterling Bancorp (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2010 and the consolidated statement of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2010 and 2009. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2010, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and the financial position of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Sterling Bancorp’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 25, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ Crowe Horwath LLP
Livingston, New Jersey
February 25, 2011

PAGE 114


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

(KPMG LOGO)

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Sterling Bancorp:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Sterling Bancorp and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2008, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2008. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Sterling Bancorp and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2008, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ KPMG LLP
New York, New York
March 13, 2009, except as to Note 1(t) which is as of February 25, 2010

PAGE 115


ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

As required under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Company’s management, with the participation of the Company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, evaluated the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) as of the end of the period covered by this annual report on Form 10-K. Based on this evaluation the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that, as of December 31, 2010, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms.

(b) Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

The management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control system is designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of published financial statements.

Any system of internal control, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations, including the possibility that a control can be circumvented or overridden and misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. Also, because of changes in conditions, internal control effectiveness may vary over time. Accordingly, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changed conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

The management of the Company assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010. In making its assessment of internal control over financial reporting, management used the criteria issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control—Integrated Framework. Based on this assessment, the Company’s management concluded that, as of December 31, 2010, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.

Crowe Horwath LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the consolidated financial statements of the Company included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has issued an attestation report on the effectiveness of the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010. The report, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, is included in this Item under the heading “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” below.

PAGE 116


(c) Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

We have audited Sterling Bancorp’s (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Sterling Bancorp’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, Sterling Bancorp maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended of Sterling Bancorp and the consolidated statement of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 and our report dated February 25, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

/s/ Crowe Horwath LLP
Livingston, New Jersey
February 25, 2011

PAGE 117


(e) Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

No change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) occurred during the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2010 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

None.

PAGE 118


PART III

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Information regarding executive officers required by Item 401 of Regulation S-K is furnished in a separate disclosure beginning on page 30 at the end of Part I of this report. The other information required by Item 10 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 within 120 days after December 31, 2010 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by Item 11 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 within 120 days after December 31, 2010 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

See the information appearing in Note 19 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements beginning on page 93.

The following table provides information as of December 31, 2010, regarding securities issued to all of the Company’s employees under equity compensation plans that were in effect during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010, and other equity compensation plan information.

EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Plan Category

 

Number of Securities
to be Issued
upon Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
(a)

 

Weighted Average
Exercise Price of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
(b)

 

Number of Securities
Remaining Available
for Future Issuance under
Equity Compensation
Plans (excluding
securities reflected
in column (a))
(c)

 









Equity Compensation Plans approved by security holders

 

 

422,747

 

$

17.73

 

 

649,190

 

Equity Compensation Plans not approved by security holders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 










Total

 

 

422,747

 

$

17.73

 

 

649,190

 

 

 










The other information required by Item 12 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 within 120 days after December 31, 2010 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

The information required by Item 13 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 within 120 days after December 31, 2010 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

The information required by Item 14 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 within 120 days after December 31, 2010 and is incorporated herein by reference.

PAGE 119


PART IV

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

 

 

 

 

(a)

The documents filed as a part of this report are listed below:

 

 

 

1.

Financial Statements
Sterling Bancorp

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2010 and 2009

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008

 

 

Sterling National Bank

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Condition as of December 31, 2010 and 2009

 

 

 

 

2.

Financial Statement Schedules

 

 

 

None

 

 

 

 

3.

Exhibits

 

 

 

3.

(i)

Restated Certificate of Incorporation filed with the State of New York Department of State on October 28, 2004 (Filed as Exhibit 3(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ii)

Certificate of Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation filed with the New York Department of State on December 18, 2008. (Filed as Exhibit 3(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(iii)

By-Laws as in effect on November 15, 2007 (Filed as Exhibit 3(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated November 15, 2007 and filed on November 19, 2007 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.

(a)

Pursuant to Regulation S-K, Item 601(b)(4) (iii)(A), no instrument which defines the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Registrant or any of its consolidated subsidiaries is filed herewith. Pursuant to this regulation, the Registrant hereby agrees to furnish a copy of any such instrument to the SEC upon request.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(b)

Warrant to Purchase up to 516,817 shares of Common Stock (Filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 23, 2008 and filed on December 30, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10.

(i)(A)

Sterling Bancorp Stock Incentive Plan (Amended and Restated as of May 20, 2004) (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(i)(B)

Form of Award Letter for Non-Employee Directors (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(i)(C)

Form of Award Letter for Officers (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(i)(D)

Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Award (Filed as Exhibit 10(A) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated March 18, 2005 and filed on March 24, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(i)(E)

Form of Award Letter for Officers (Filed as Exhibit 10(i)(E) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(i)(F)

Amendment to Sterling Bancorp Stock Incentive Plan (Filed as Exhibit 10(i)(F) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ii)(A)

Sterling Bancorp Key Executive Incentive Bonus Plan (Filed as Exhibit C to the Registrant’s definitive Proxy Statement, dated March 13, 2001, filed on March 16, 2001 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ii)(B) 

Amendment to Sterling Bancorp Key Executive Incentive Bonus Plan (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii) (B) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(iii)(A) 

Amended and Restated Employment Agreements dated March 22, 2002 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(i)(a) and 10(i)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).

PAGE 120



 

 

(iii)(B)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated February 26, 2003 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 3.10(xiv)(a) and 3.10(xiv)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(C)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated February 24, 2004 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(xv)(a) and 10(xv)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K dated December 31, 2003 and filed on March 12, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(D)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 18, 2005 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(B) and 10(C), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated March 18, 2005 and filed on March 24, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(E)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 18, 2006 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(E)(a) and 10(iii)(E)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(F)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 15, 2007 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(F)(a) and 10(iii)(F)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(G)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 13, 2008 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(G)(a) and 10(iii)(G)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(H)

Amendments dated December 29, 2008 to Employment Agreements (a) For Louis J. Cappelli and (b) For John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibit 10(iii)(H) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(I)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 12, 2009 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(I)(a) and 10(iii)(I)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iii)(J)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 25, 2010

 

(a) For Louis J. Cappelli

 

(b) For John C. Millman

 

 

(iv)(A)

Form of Change of Control Severance Agreement entered into May 21, 1999 between the Registrant and each of six executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1999 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(B)

Amendment to Form of Change of Control Severance Agreement dated February 6, 2002 entered into between the Registrant and each of four executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(C)

Form of Change of Control Severance Agreement dated April 3, 2002 entered into between the Registrant and one executive (Filed as Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(D)

Form of Change of Control Severance Agreement dated June 8, 2004 entered into between the Registrant and one executive (Filed as Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(E)

Form of Change of Control Severance and Retention Agreement, dated as of November 7, 2006, entered into between the Registrant and one officer (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(F)

Form of Change of Control Severance and Retention Agreement, dated as of September 7, 2006, entered into between the Registrant and one officer (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(F) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).

PAGE 121



 

 

(iv)(G)

Form of Amendment dated December 29, 2008 to Form of Change in Control Severance Agreement between the Company and each of three executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(G) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(iv)(H)

Form of Amendment dated December 29, 2008 to Form of Change in Control Severance and Retention Agreement between the Company and each of six executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(H) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(v)(A)

Letter Agreement, dated December 23, 2008, including the Securities Purchase Agreement — Standard Terms incorporated by reference therein, between the Company and the U.S. Treasury (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 23, 2008 and filed on December 30, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(v)(B)

Form of Waiver, executed by each of Louis J. Cappelli, John C. Millman, John W. Tietjen, Howard M. Applebaum and Eliot Robinson (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 23, 2008 and filed on December 30, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

(v)(C)

Form of Letter Agreement, executed by each of Louis J. Cappelli, John C. Millman, John W. Tietjen, Howard M. Applebaum and Eliot Robinson (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 23, 2008 and filed on December 30, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

11.

Statement re: Computation of Per Share Earnings.

 

 

12.

Statement re: Computation of Ratios.

 

 

16.

Letter re: Change in Certifying Accountant (Filed as Exhibit 16.1 to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated March 23, 2009 and filed on March 27, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

21.

Subsidiaries of the Registrant.

 

 

23.1

Consent of Crowe Horwath LLP Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

 

23.2

Consent of KPMG LLP Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

 

31.1

Certification of the CEO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-14(a).

 

 

31.2

Certification of the CFO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-14(a).

 

 

32.

Certifications of the CEO and CFO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code.

 

 

99.1

Certification of the CEO under Section 111(b)(4) of EESA.

 

 

99.2

Certification of the CFO under Section 111(b)(4) of EESA.


PAGE 122


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

STERLING BANCORP

 

/s/ Louis J. Cappelli


Louis J. Cappelli, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

 

February 25, 2011


Date

 

/s/ John W. Tietjen


John W. Tietjen, Executive Vice President

(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

 

February 25, 2011


Date

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ Louis J. Cappelli


 


(Date)

 

Louis J. Cappelli

 

 

Director, Chairman and

 

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

(Principal Executive Officer)

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ John W. Tietjen


 


(Date)

 

John W. Tietjen

 

 

Executive Vice President

 

 

(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ John C. Millman


 


(Date)

 

John C. Millman

 

 

Director

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ Henry J. Humphreys


 


(Date)

 

Henry J. Humphreys

 

 

Director

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ Joseph M. Adamko


 


(Date)

 

Joseph M. Adamko

 

 

Director

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ Robert W. Lazar


 


(Date)

 

Robert W. Lazar

 

 

Director

 

 

 

February 25, 2011

 

/s/ Eugene T. Rossides


 


(Date)

 

Eugene T. Rossides

 

 

Director

PAGE 123


EXHIBIT INDEX

 

 

 

10.

 (iii)(J)

Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 25, 2010:

 

 

(a) For Louis J. Cappelli

 

 

(b) For John C. Millman

 

 

 

11.

 

Statement re: Computation of Per Share Earnings.

 

 

 

12.

 

Statement re: Computation of Ratios.

 

 

 

21.

 

Subsidiaries of the Registrant.

 

 

 

23.1.

 

Consent of Crowe Horwath LLP Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

 

 

23.2.

 

Consent of KPMG LLP Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

 

 

31.1.

 

Certification of the CEO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13A–14(A).

 

 

 

31.2.

 

Certification of the CFO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13A–14(A).

 

 

 

32.

 

Certifications of the CEO and CFO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code.

 

 

 

99.1.

 

Certification of the CEO under Section 111(b)(4) of EESA.

 

 

 

99.2.

 

Certification of the CFO under Section 111(b)(4) of EESA.